Commit graph

4512 commits

Author SHA1 Message Date
Janusz Dziedzic
56e2fc2c31 wpa_supplicant: Add ctrl parameter to INTERFACES command
"INTERFACES ctrl" can now be used to fetch a list of network interfaces
and their control interfaces, e.g., to fetch the UDP port information
for the control interface.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 17:44:49 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
acf57fae76 ctrl_iface_common: Use sockaddr_storage instead of sockaddr_un
This is a step towards allowing UDP sockets to be used with the common
implementation.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 17:15:05 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
1a2124c650 wpa_supplicant: Use common functions for ctrl_iface
Use the common functions, structures when UNIX socket ctrl_iface used.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 17:15:05 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
d60886cdaf wpa_supplicant: Add monitor support for global UDP ctrl_iface
Add monitor support (ATTACH/DETACH) for the global ctrl_iface when using
the UDP backend.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 10:46:13 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
f0e5d3b5c6 wpa_supplicant: Share attach/detach/send UDP ctrl_iface functions
Extend the previously per-interface UDP ctrl_iface functions
(attach/detach/send) to support operations on the global interface as
well.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 10:21:18 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
db7fb435f3 wpa_supplicant: Allow UDP ctrl_iface configuration to set the UDP port
This allows the UDP port to be set for the per-interface and global
control interfaces. The format is: udp:<port_no>

For example:
wpa_supplicant -Dnl80211 -ddt -g udp:9888

And in the configuration file:
ctrl_interface=udp:9877

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 10:15:57 +02:00
Eliad Peller
c69ef1d2da P2P: Respect p2p_ignore_shared_freq on p2p_group_add
Make sure wpas_p2p_init_go_params() respects the p2p_ignore_shared_freq
configuration option. Choose currently used frequencies only if this
option is not set, or if there are no unused channels left.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2016-03-04 21:17:32 +02:00
Eliad Peller
4115b0524b P2P: Fix shared freq print in wpas_p2p_init_go_params()
"freq" contains the forced frequency, not the selected one. Print the
correct freq instead.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2016-03-04 21:16:00 +02:00
Ben Rosenfeld
a805731086 P2P: Abort ongoing scan when p2p_find is stopped
When p2p_find is stopped, send request to the driver
in order to cancel an ongoing scan if there is one.

Signed-off-by: Ben Rosenfeld <ben.rosenfeld@intel.com>
2016-03-03 17:10:26 +02:00
Ilan Peer
1446afc865 wpa_supplicant: Handle EVENT_SCAN_RESULTS when an interface is disabled
An interface can be disabled while it has an ongoing scan request.
In such a case, when the scan results notification is received,
it was being ignored (as the interface is already disabled) so the
scan state was not cleared. This can cause undetermined behavior
for the next scan request.

To handle this, clear the scan state when EVENT_SCAN_RESULTS is
received and the interface is disabled.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2016-03-03 17:10:26 +02:00
Avraham Stern
d14e63a2aa WNM: Do not scan based on malformed BSS Transition Management Request
Verify that when the Candidate List Included bit is set in a BSS
Transition Management Request frame, the candidate list actually
includes at least one candidate. If no candidates are included, reject
the request without scanning.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-03-03 17:10:25 +02:00
Avraham Stern
f420577f3c WNM: Fix candidates count in BSS Transition Management Request
In BSS Transition Management Request frame, it is possible that vendor
specific IEs are included after the candidate list. In this case the
candidates count was incremented for each IE although the candidate list
is already over which could result in adding all zeros candidates into
the neighbor list.

Fix that by incrementing the candidates count only for neighbor report
elements.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-03-03 17:09:26 +02:00
Ilan Peer
3c58df7ae7 wpa_cli: Support running action script on global control interface
In case wpa_cli is started with an option to execute an action script,
but no interface is specified, wpa_cli might crash in wpa_cli_exec() if
arg1 == NULL. Fix this be setting arg1 = "global".

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2016-03-03 16:30:28 +02:00
Adam Langley
8f38eed628 Android: Remove superfluous OpenSSL include paths
The libcrypto and libssl modules (and their respective static and host
versions) use LOCAL_EXPORT_C_INCLUDE_DIRS thus just including the module
is sufficient.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2016-03-03 16:27:10 +02:00
Daichi Ueura
cbf8d181c3 HS 2.0R2: Clear fetch_anqp_in_progress if fopen fails
Clear wpa_s->fetch_anqp_in_progress when osu-providers.txt can't be
opened. An issue happens, for instance, when wpa_supplicant doesn't
have correct access permission to the directory specified by osu_dir.
If hs20_osu_fetch_done method returns without clearing the flag,
'FETCH_OSU' command will never work correctly.

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2016-03-03 16:25:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2bf9a53a8b Add EAP-AKA' and EAP-pwd to wpa_supplicant README
The EAP methods were missing from the lists.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 16:19:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4196c08e8b Update notes about OpenSSL versions
Obsolete OpenSSL versions 0.9.* are not supported anymore.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 16:17:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5d7b1a3c82 Fix some typos in wpa_supplicant README files
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 16:15:46 +02:00
Nishant Chaprana
4194fee565 README-P2P: Fix a typo
Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2016-03-03 16:00:34 +02:00
Lior David
c58eed6dc7 P2P: Add Dev Info attribute to Probe Request frames in 60 GHz
When building P2P IE for Probe Request frames in P2P scan, add the
device information attribute if the 60 GHz band is included in the scan,
since this is required by the P2P specification.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 15:13:56 +02:00
Lior David
2b6e9f91df wpa_supplicant: Expose wpas_get_bands() and related API
Expose the functions wpas_get_bands() and wpas_freq_to_band() and the
enum wpa_radio_work_band, since they will be needed outside
wpa_supplicant.c.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 15:10:50 +02:00
Lior David
94ad3c3389 P2P: Change order of P2P IE and frequencies set up
When setting up parameters for P2P scan, calculate the frequencies
for the scan before calculating the scan IE. This is because
the scan IE calculation may need information about the scan
frequencies in use.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 15:03:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bef5e9a862 Fix scan rescheduling from wpas_stop_pno to check postponed case
Commit 02e122a995 ('Reschedule scan from
wpas_stop_pno if it was postponed') uses wpa_s->scanning as the only
condition for automatically starting a postponed scan request from
EVENT_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED event handler. However, wpa_s->scanning may be
set for sched_scan and as such, this can result in unexpected extra
scans without there having been any real postponed request.

Make this more accurate by verifying that there really is a pending
request for a scan before speeding up its start.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 11:04:38 +02:00
Lior David
96a26ab744 P2P: Support dedicated P2P_DEVICE without separate group interface
Add support for drivers with dedicated P2P_DEVICE interface, but without
group interface concurrency (only a single netdev is used). With such
devices, wpa_supplicant tried to use the p2p_dev interface instead of
the group interface and most P2P operations failed. Extend
wpa_supplicant to use the primary interface instead of a separate group
interface in such cases.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-27 19:37:19 +02:00
Lior David
ba307f8528 P2P: Add a separate pointer to the P2P Device instance
In many places in the code there was a reference to wpa_s->parent to get
from group interface to p2p_dev interface. These places can break if
P2P_DEVICE interface would need to be used with the primary interface as
the group interface, since the parent of the primary interface points to
itself and not the p2p_dev interface.

Fix this by adding a separate "p2pdev" pointer to wpa_supplicant,
it will be the same as parent pointer in most cases but whenever
the primary interface is used as a group interface, change it to
point to the correct p2p_dev interface.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-27 19:37:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e04019737e GAS client: Make PMF check on RX more consistent
Use the SA field instead of BSSID in the received Action frame to
determine whether PMF has been negotiated with the transmitter. While
these fields are supposed to be same for Public Action frames from an
AP, it would be possible that a frame is received with different values.
The following operations in gas_query_rx() use SA, so do the same for
the PMF check.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-27 19:37:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0645492e7c WNM: Optimize a single BSS transition management candidate scan
If the BSS Transition Management Request frame includes only a single
candidate and we need to scan for the BSS to get up-to-date information,
use a scan for the known BSSID instead of wildcard BSSID. In addition,
set the SSID in the scan if it is known based on old scan results in the
BSS table. This removes unnecessary Probe Response frames when we are
interested in results from only a single BSS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-26 17:19:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
eb20cea590 nl80211: Add an option to specify the BSSID to scan for
This allows scans to be optimized when a response is needed only from a
single, known BSS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-26 17:19:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
940491ce08 MBO: Mandate use of PMF for WPA2+MBO association (STA)
If WPA2 is used, MBO AP must enable PMF. Refuse to select a BSS that has
MBO and WPA2 enabled without PMF.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6332aaf3b2 MBO: Track STA cellular data capability from association request
This makes hostapd parse the MBO attribute in (Re)Association Request
frame and track the cellular data capability (mbo_cell_capa=<val> in STA
control interface command).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d010048cf7 MBO: Expire non-matching bss_tmp_disallowed entries as part of check
This makes wpa_is_bss_tmp_disallowed() expire old entries from the
bss_tmp_disallowed list even if they do not match the BSSID that is
being searched for. This allows the list to be kept at shorter length to
speed up operations and minimize memory use in cases where the
previously disabled BSS is not in radio range anymore.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
016082e9e6 MBO: Send WNM-Notification when cellular capabilities change
Send a WNM-Notification to the associated AP to indicate changes in
cellular data capabilities.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
c484b19882 Move Hotspot 2.0 element in (Re)Association Request frames
According to IEEE Std 802.11-2012, Table 8-22, vendor specific elements
must follow all other elements, so Hotspot 2.0 element which is actually
a vendor specific element must come after all other elements.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
a0c38e5dd7 Re-order elements in (Re)Association Request frames
According to IEEE Std 802.11-2012, Table 8-22, RM Enabled Capabilities
element must come before the Extended Capabilities element.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
9a493fab73 WNM: Add candidate list to BSS transition query
Add an option to configure a candidate list to BSS transition query
("list" as the second argument to WNM_BSS_QUERY). The candidate list is
built from the available scan results. If no updated scan results (< 10
sec) are available, the command fails.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
84d1c0fd5a WNM: Add candidate list to BSS transition response
Add the transition candidate list to BSS Transition Management Response
frame. The candidates preference is set using the regular wpa_supplicant
BSS selection logic. If the BSS transition request is rejected and
updated scan results are not available, the list is not added.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
c8082d2b6a MBO: Add MBO IE to BSS Transition Management Response frame
When rejecting a BSS Transition Management Request frame, add MBO IE to
the BSS Transition Management Response frame to specify the transition
rejection reason.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
dd5999084e MBO: Parse MBO IE in BSS Transition Management Request frames
Add parsing of MBO IE in BSS Transition Management Request frames. If
the MBO IE includes the association retry delay attribute, do not try to
reconnect to the current BSS until the delay time is over.

If the MBO IE includes the cellular data connection preference attribute
or the transition rejection reason attribute, send a message to upper
layers with the data.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
5e57ba2505 MBO: Add Supported Operating Classes element to Association Request
Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
7d46f586de MBO: Add global operating class definitions
Add definitions for global operating classes. These definitions will be
used to construct supported operating classes information element.

The operating classes definitions used locally for P2P module will be
removed and included in the general operating classes definitions.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
David Spinadel
cb06cf3456 MBO: Prevent association to APs that explicitly disallow this
Prevent association to MBO APs that have association disallowed
attribute in MBO IE in Beacon or Probe Response frames.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
David Spinadel
c5d193d7b3 MBO: Add cellular capability to MBO IE
Add cellular capability attribute to MBO IE and add MBO IE with cellular
capabilities to Probe Request frames. By default, cellular capability
value is set to Not Cellular capable (3).

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
David Spinadel
2d5b8614b7 MBO: Send MBO WNM-Notification Request frames to notify changes
Send a WNM-Notification Request frame with Non-preferred Channel Report
subelement if the non-preferred channels list changes during an
association.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
David Spinadel
92c6e2e3a9 MBO: Implement MBO non-preferred channel report in Association Request
Add MBO IE with non-preferred channels to (Re)Association Request
frames.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
David Spinadel
facf2c728a MBO: Add non-preferred channel configuration in wpa_supplicant
Add non-preferred channel configuration to wpa_config for MBO.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-02-21 17:55:16 +02:00
Avraham Stern
231b04b6cb utils: Share a single helper function to get IE by ID
Add a helper function to find a certain IE inside IEs buffer by ID and
use this function in several places that implemented similar
functionality locally.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-21 17:14:56 +02:00
Avraham Stern
ea69d9737c wpa_supplicant: Share a single get_mode() implementation
There is no need to duplicate this helper function in multiple files.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-21 17:14:51 +02:00
Nick Lowe
98a516eae8 WPS: Use only os_get_random() for PIN generation
Remove the fallback dependency on os_random() when generating a WPS pin.
This is exceptionally unlikely to ever be called as the call to
os_get_random() is unlikely to fail. The intention is to facilitate
future removal of os_random() as it uses a low quality PRNG.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-19 18:44:40 +02:00
Nick Lowe
8c676b5056 Add RADIUS Service-Type attribute with a value of Framed
This seems to be the common value used by APs and also mentioned in RFC
3580.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-19 18:44:39 +02:00
Masashi Honma
70c93963ed SAE: Fix PMKID calculation for PMKSA cache
The SAE PMKID is calculated with IEEE Std 802.11-2012 11.3.5.4, but the
PMKID was re-calculated with 11.6.1.3 and saved into PMKSA cache. Fix
this to save the PMKID calculated with 11.3.5.4 into the PMKSA cache.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-02-18 21:07:47 +02:00
Roy Marples
640b0b933a ctype functions require an unsigned char
Ensure that characters are represented as unsigned char when using
isblank() and isspace(). These function take in a "int c" argument, but
it needs to be unsigned for the cases where EOF is not indicated.

Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-02-18 17:39:00 +02:00
Roy Marples
634e2e29d6 Add CONFIG_ELOOP_KQUEUE to defconfig
Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-02-18 17:02:13 +02:00
Michael Braun
ba91e92023 wpa_supplicant: Parse ifname argument from DATA_TEST_CONFIG
This is required to test tagged VLANs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-17 11:46:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ddd0032e03 wpa_cli: Clean up logical operation
While '!func() == 0' here resulted in correct behavior, it is not clear
and clang is starting to warn about this (-Wlogical-not-parentheses).
Use 'func()' instead as the condition to clear this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-16 15:52:08 +02:00
Lior David
b907491281 wpa_supplicant: Basic support for PBSS/PCP
PBSS (Personal Basic Service Set) is a new BSS type for DMG
networks. It is similar to infrastructure BSS, having an AP-like
entity called PCP (PBSS Control Point), but it has few differences.
PBSS support is mandatory for IEEE 802.11ad devices.

Add a new "pbss" argument to network block. The argument is used
in the following scenarios:
1. When network has mode=2 (AP), when pbss flag is set will start
as a PCP instead of an AP.
2. When network has mode=0 (station), when pbss flag is set will
connect to PCP instead of AP.

The function wpa_scan_res_match() was modified to match BSS according to
the pbss flag in the network block (wpa_ssid structure). When pbss flag
is set it will match only PCPs, and when it is clear it will match only
APs.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-08 22:23:56 +02:00
Roy Marples
f9982b3212 Implement kqueue(2) support via CONFIG_ELOOP_KQUEUE
NOTE: kqueue has to be closed and re-build after forking. epoll *should*
do the same, but it seems that wpa_supplicant doesn't need it at least.

I have re-worked a little bit of the epoll code (moved into a similar
kqueue function) so it's trivial to requeue epoll if needed in the
future.

Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-02-07 18:09:19 +02:00
Roy Marples
2e69bdd16a eloop: Add eloop_sock_requeue()
This function can be used to re-build eloop socket tables after forking
for eloop implementations that need this.

Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-02-07 12:38:04 +02:00
Lubomir Rintel
df9e2c2a55 D-Bus: Don't do <deny send_interface="..." /> in dbus service file
It does more than intended; apart from denying messages to that
particular interface it also denies all messages non-qualified with an
interface globally. This blocks messages completely unrelated to
wpa_supplicant, such as NetworkManager communication with the VPN
plugins.

From the dbus-daemon manual:

  Be careful with send_interface/receive_interface, because the
  interface field in messages is optional. In particular, do NOT
  specify <deny send_interface="org.foo.Bar"/>! This will cause
  no-interface messages to be blocked for all services, which is almost
  certainly not what you intended. Always use rules of the form: <deny
  send_interface="org.foo.Bar" send_destination="org.foo.Service"/>

We can just safely remove those rules, since we're sufficiently
protected by the send_destination matches and method calls are
disallowed by default anyway.

Signed-off-by: Lubomir Rintel <lkundrak@v3.sk>
2016-02-07 11:55:09 +02:00
Srinivasa Duvvuri
9684c7567e mesh: Fix peer link counting when a mesh peer reconnects
When a mesh point reconnects by starting from Authentication frame
sequence, the plink count was not decremented from its last connection.
This resulted in leaking peer link count and causing wpa_supplicant to
reject the connection after max_peer_links (default: 99) reconnects.

This was reproduced by pre-configuring 2 mesh points with mesh
credentials. Boot both mesh points and make sure they connect to each
other. Then in a loop reboot one of the mesh points after it
successfully connects while leaving the other mesh point up and running.
After 99 iterations the supplicant on mesh point that is not rebooting
will reject the connection request from the other mesh point.

Fix this by decrementing num_plinks when freeing a STA entry that is
still in PLINK_ESTAB state.

Signed-off-by: Srinivasa Duvvuri <sduvvuri@chromium.org>
2016-02-06 21:22:29 +02:00
Avraham Stern
83fe38b011 P2P: Fall back to no VHT when starting AP/P2P GO
In cases where the bandwidth is not set when starting an AP/P2P GO,
the code tries to use 160 MHz or 80 MHz channels. As a result, the
AP/P2P GO configuration is set to use these channel widths even if
they are not available, which may results in failing to start the
AP/P2P GO.

Fix this by changing the AP/P2P GO configuration not to use VHT channels
when they are not available. In this case the AP/P2P GO will use a 40
MHz channel, if available, or a 20 MHz channel, if this is the maximum
available width.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-06 18:23:33 +02:00
Nick Lowe
2cbc6ffb3a RADIUS: Redesign Request Authenticator generation
Simplify and make properly random the generation of the Request
Authenticator.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-06 17:19:35 +02:00
Roy Marples
a3cc64f3d2 Remove -w support from wpa_supplicant README
wpa_supplicant dropped the -w option long long time ago..

Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-02-06 00:31:26 +02:00
John Ernberg
f91e11f465 D-Bus: Fix p2p interface capability message
If the config file for the interface says "p2p_disabled=1", don't report
p2p capabilities on this interface. This helps programs like Connman to
not enable p2p when it's been disabled in wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: John Ernberg <john.ernberg@actia.se>
2016-02-05 18:09:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
80ce804e88 WNM: Workaround for broken AP operating class behavior
Some APs do not advertise operating classes correctly for BSS Transition
Management. Try to determine the most likely operating frequency based
on the channel number (1..14 --> 2.4 GHz; 36..169 --> 5 GHz) if invalid
op_class == 0 is received in a BSS Transition Management Request. This
speeds up the following operating by avoiding a full scan due to an
unknown channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-05 17:06:06 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
17d32eb3d3 Allow re-write of ip_addr* configurations to conf file.
This patch keeps ip_addr* configuration in conf file while
 updating supplicant conf file either internally by supplicant or
 due to save_config command.

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Avichal Agarwal <avichal.a@samsung.com>
2016-01-15 20:23:25 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
bcce934755 dbus: Restrict DeviceName size to 32 characters in setter
The maximum WPS Device Name length is 32 characters and that limit was
already enforced for the control interface and configuration files.

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
2016-01-15 20:16:13 +02:00
Roy Marples
7c70fe2c6e Sort options and reduce printf calls in wpa_supplicant usage text
Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-01-15 20:11:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d20c66e45 P2P: Clear groups first on FLUSH command
This is needed to get proper P2P group removal processing for some test
cases. discovery_group_client followed by nfc_p2p_client was able to hit
a case where the P2P group idle timeout survived to the next group
instance because of the FLUSH command not clearing the group and this
timeout properly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-06 18:49:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
27446e471c mesh: Do not force another peering exchange on driver event
If the local driver indicated a peer candidate event when the peer had
already initiated peering exchange in open mesh case, we used to force a
new exchange to be started instead of allowing the previously started
exchange to complete. This is not desirable, so make this initiation of
the new exchange conditional on there not being an already started (or
successfully completed) exchange.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-06 17:50:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cc64fe7b9e mesh: Do not clear link state on driver event if exchange was started
If the local driver event for a new peer candidate arrived only after
the peer had already initiated the peering exchange, we used to clear
the link state. This resulted in the already completed (or in progress)
exchange getting abandoned and a new exchange initiated. This is not
desirable since the already started (or even completed) exchange can be
used. Clear the link state only when adding the new STA entry for the
first time, i.e., use the same !sta->my_lid condition in handling the
driver event similarly to how the peer initiated cases were already
handled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-06 17:50:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b5f5c32412 mesh: Add some more details to MPM debug messages
This makes it easier to follow the debug log when trying to figure out
issues with mesh peering exchange.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-06 17:50:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6174de663c mesh: Connection and group started/removed events into debug log
The messages were sent out with wpa_msg_ctrl() so they were not visible
in the debug log. However, these would be quite helpful strings to
search for in the debug log, so change these messages to use wpa_msg().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-06 13:13:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e9ccfc38fd Clear wpa_supplicant state to DISCONNECTED on FLUSH command
It was possible for the FLUSH command to trigger auto connect mechanism
to schedule a new scan in 100 ms. This is not desired since all the
network profiles will be removed immediately and the scan or an attempt
to reconnect would not be of any benefit here. Such a scan in 100 ms can
cause issues for cases where multiple test sequences are run back to
back, so prevent this by clearing wpa_supplicant state to DISCONNECTED
(which avoids scheduling of the 100 ms scan trigger on disconnection) if
the state was AUTHENTICATING or higher when the FLUSH command was
issued.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-04 23:37:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aeb408fff1 HS 2.0: Add some documentation for OSEN and network block use
This adds notes on how wpa_supplicant can be configured for OSEN for a
link-layer protected online signup connection and how network profiles
can be set for a Hotspot 2.0 data connection when using external
Interworking network selection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-04 21:34:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
15c5606758 Update copyright notices for the new year 2016
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-01 13:42:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6e379c6c16 WPS: Testing mechanism to force auth/encr type flags
The new wps_force_{auth,encr}_types parameters can be used in test build
(CONFIG_WPS_TESTING) to force wpa_supplicant to use the specified value
in the Authentication/Encryption Type flags attribute. This can be used
to test AP behavior on various error cases for which there are
workarounds to cover deployed device behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-01 13:42:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
944f693591 P2P: Stop offchannel TX wait on P2P_STOP_FIND/P2P_LISTEN
Previously it was possible for the pending Action frame TX to be
cleared, but the offchannel TX operation being left in wait state in the
kernel. This would delay start of the next operation (e.g., that listen
operation requested by P2P_LISTEN) until the wait time for the
previously pending Action frame had expired.

Optimize this by explicitly stopping any pending offchannel Action frame
TX when clearing the internal offchannel TX state in
wpas_p2p_clear_pending_action_tx().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-31 00:03:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8edd9f1058 P2P: Add an option to specify group SSID in P2P_CONNECT join case
The new optional ssid=<hexdump> argument to P2P_CONNECT can be used to
make P2P Client operations during join-an-existing-group more robust by
filtering out scan results based on the SSID in addition to the P2P
Device/Interface Address. This can help if the same MAC address has been
used in multiple groups recently and the cached scan results may still
include an older BSS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 19:12:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
70e0cb33f2 P2P: Provide group SSID, if specified, to P2P Client join step
At least one of the wpas_p2p_connect() callers (NFC join case) already
had access to the Group SSID. Pass that information through
wpas_p2p_connect() to wpas_p2p_join() so that the join operation can
filter out incorrect groups more easily.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 19:08:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
438be60153 P2P: Do not accept any GO BSS entry if SSID is specified for join
Accept only a BSS entry matching the SSID when trying to find the
operating channel of a GO during join operation for which the SSID was
already specified. Previously, it could have been possible to pick an
incorrect BSS entry if the new GO was not found in the latest scan and
there was an older cached scan entry for the same BSSID.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 19:06:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
35510d530a P2P: Use join SSID in the skip-PD cases
It was already possible to limit join operation to accept only a
specific SSID. However, this constraint was not used when starting a P2P
Client interface as a WPS Enrollee without going through a Provision
Discovery exchange.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 19:04:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8b8d4f4eb4 P2P: Do not accept any BSS entry for join if SSID is already known
Use wpa_bss_get() with the specific Group SSID instead of
wpa_bss_get_bssid_latest() if the SSID is already known. This makes the
P2P join operations more robust in case the frequency of the group was
not yet known and the same P2P Interface Address may have been used in
multiple group instances with an older group entry still present in the
cached scan results.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 19:02:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b875276c4d P2P: Use group SSID, if known, for join operation even if no BSS entry
This allows the cases where a specific group SSID is known to filter out
groups on the P2P Client even if the specific BSS entry for the target
group is not yet available.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 19:00:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aa256cb399 P2PS: Add group SSID, if known, to the P2PS-PROV-DONE event
The new optional group_ssid=<hexdump> argument in the P2PS-PROV-DONE
event can be used to help in identifying the exact group if there have
been multiple groups with the same P2P Interface Address in short period
of time.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-30 18:59:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c2ed779748 mesh: Document Mesh Peering Management element structure in more detail
Provide details on the pointers to the subfields and rename "pmk" to
"chosen_pmk" and use SAE_PMKID_LEN macro with it to make the code more
readable.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-28 17:21:08 +02:00
Bob Copeland
b2817cd5c2 mesh: Check PMKID in AMPE Action frames
From IEEE Std 802.11-2012 13.3.5:

   If the incoming Mesh Peering Management frame is for AMPE and the
   Chosen PMK from the received frame contains a PMKID that does not
   identify a valid mesh PMKSA, the frame shall be silently discarded.

We were not checking the PMKID previously, and we also weren't parsing
it correctly, so fix both.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-12-28 17:21:08 +02:00
Bob Copeland
6c33eed3ee mesh: Fix PMKID to match the standard
IEEE Std 802.11-2012 11.3.5.4 specifies the PMKID for SAE-derived keys
as:

   L((commit-scalar + peer-commit-scalar) mod r, 0, 128)

This is already calculated in the SAE code when the PMK is derived, but
not saved anywhere. Later, when generating the PMKID for plink action
frames, the definition for PMKID from 11.6.1.3 is incorrectly used.
Correct this by saving the PMKID when the key is generated and use it
subsequently.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-12-28 17:21:08 +02:00
Ilan Peer
ede7770180 wpa_supplicant: Do not wait for monitor on P2P Device interface
External programs are not aware of the creation of a
dedicated P2P Device interface, so it does not make sense
to wait for a monitor to connect on such an interface.

Fix this by not waiting on a dedicated P2P Device interface
for monitor to attach.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-12-28 17:21:08 +02:00
Ilan Peer
1c94570f1b Do not wait for monitor to attach if no control interface
In case an interface has started without a control interface
initialized, skip waiting for monitor to attach at the start of
wpa_supplicant (-W).

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-12-28 17:21:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f98674aa37 Clone default LIBS value to LIBS_* for other tools
If LIBS is set with some global build system defaults, clone those for
LIBS_c, LIBS_h, LIBS_n, and LIBS_p to cover wpa_cli, wpa_passphrase,
hostapd_cli, hlr_auc_gw, and nt_password_hash as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-28 17:21:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7d2f67433d Add "GET_CAPABILITY acs" to allow ACS build option to be detected
This allows upper layer software to check whether wpa_supplicant can use
ACS for AP mode.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-24 22:24:05 +02:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
d99097177a wpa_supplicant: Enable Automatic Channel Selection support for AP mode
Since hostapd supports ACS now, let's enable its support in
wpa_supplicant as well when starting AP mode.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
[u.oelmann@pengutronix.de: rebased series from hostap_2_1~944 to master]
[u.oelmann@pengutronix.de: adjusted added text in defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Ulrich Ölmann <u.oelmann@pengutronix.de>
2015-12-24 22:24:05 +02:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
96bc508684 Handle survey event properly in wpa_supplicant
Let's reuse hostapd code for such handling. This will be useful to get
ACS support into wpa_supplicant where this one needs to handle the
survey event so it fills in the result ACS subsystem will require.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
[u.oelmann@pengutronix.de: rebased series from hostap_2_1~944 to master]
Signed-off-by: Ulrich Ölmann <u.oelmann@pengutronix.de>
2015-12-24 21:35:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
662512e027 P2PS: Remove dead code
Commit f8a80e39b3 ('P2PS: Change
connection capability handling') added the identical P2PS_SETUP_CLIENT
check into two places within p2ps_group_capability(). However, only the
first one of these can be reached. In the second case, role can only
have values 0 or P2PS_SETUP_NEW and as such, the P2PS_SETUP_CLIENT case
is not possible. It looks like the first part of the commit is
sufficient, so remove the dead code added by the second part.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-24 19:16:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d6b536f7e5 Add ocsp=3 configuration parameter for multi-OCSP
ocsp=3 extends ocsp=2 by require all not-trusted certificates in the
server certificate chain to receive a good OCSP status. This requires
support for ocsp_multi (RFC 6961). This commit is only adding the
configuration value, but all the currently included TLS library wrappers
are rejecting this as unsupported for now.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-24 00:54:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0ab0de88e8 Document previously missing key_mgmt values
Number of key_mgmt options were missing from the documentation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-21 17:45:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c24f8e8e75 GAS: Do not cancel initial offchannel wait with comeback delay 1
The minimum comeback delay 1 is used to indicate that fragmentation is
needed instead of indicating that the response is going to be available
only after some time. Do not cancel offchannel wait for this case
between the initial and comeback exchanges to avoid delaying the full
operation unnecessarily.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-20 21:07:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
364282c8c9 GAS: Retry full GAS query if comeback response is not received
It is possible for a comeback response to get lost especially when going
through a large GAS exchange fragmented to multiple frames in an
environment with interference or other traffic. Make this less likely to
fail the full exchange by trying full GAS query again and using longer
wait time on the GAS comeback exchanges.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-20 21:07:33 +02:00
Matti Gottlieb
8fb718a748 GAS: Shorten the duration of the wait for GAS comeback response
When exchanging GAS frames with the AP, the initial response from the AP
may take a while to come, since the AP may need to fetch the info from a
server. The next fragments/comeback response frames should take much
less time since the AP already has all of the info, so the wait time
for these frames can be reduced.

In addition, some drivers, e.g., mac80211, try to combine ROC based flows,
to improve medium utilization. For example, if the requested ROC fits
entirely in a previous requested ROC they can be combined. Thus, reducing
the wait time for the next frames can improve medium utilization.

Shorten the duration of GAS comeback to improve medium utilization and
overall GAS exchange times.

Signed-off-by: Matti Gottlieb <matti.gottlieb@intel.com>
2015-12-20 19:42:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c012567df6 GAS: Clear offchannel_tx_started when ending remain-on-channel
Commit 2c0d0ae370 ('GAS: End
remain-on-channel due to delayed GAS comeback request') started ending
the remain-on-channel operation between the initial request and the
following comeback request. However, it did not check or update the
offchannel_tx_started variable. While this alone would not necessarily
be problematic, this makes it more difficult to optimize wait time for
offchannel TX operations, so make sure the internal tracking variable
gets updated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-20 19:40:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e7160bd8fe Drop any pending EAPOL RX frame when starting a new connection
Such a pending frame cannot be valid anymore, so drop it instead of
risking of using an unexpected EAPOL frame after association if a
previous association received one at the end and the new association can
happen within 100 ms.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-20 17:25:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
61f25f80b4 HS 2.0: Remove duplicate icon entries
Only one of the icon entries with a matching BSSID and file name can be
fetched from wpa_supplicant and as such, there is no need to maintain
the old data if it was not explicitly deleted before running a new fetch
for the same BSSID and icon. Remove older duplicated entries whenever
completing a pending icon fetch to optimize memory use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-19 18:53:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ca9968a012 HS 2.0: Convert icon storage to use dl_list
This simplifies the list operations quite a bit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-19 18:49:57 +02:00
Jan Nordqvist
8dd5c1b4e9 HS 2.0: Add a command to retrieve icon with in-memory storage
This adds a new command based Hotspot 2.0 icon retrieval option.

In short, here is the new command sequence:
1. REQ_HS20_ICON <bssid> <file-name>
2. event: RX-HS20-ICON <bssid> <file-name> <size>
3. GET_HS20_ICON <bssid> <file-name> <offset> <size>
   (if needed, repeat with larger offset values until full icon is
   fetched)
5. DEL_HS20_ICON <bssid> <file-name>

REQ_HS20_ICON is a new command that is analogous to HS20_ICON_REQUEST
with the slight difference that an entry to store the icon in memory is
prepared. The RX-HS20-ICON event has been augmented with BSSID,
file-name and size, and GET_HS20_ICON is used to retrieve a chunk of up
to <size> bytes of icon data at offset <offset>. Each chunk is returned
as a base64 encoded fragment, preceded by "HS20-ICON-DATA", BSSID, and
file-name as well as the starting offset of the data.

If there is no entry prepared for the icon when the ANQP result comes
back, hs20_process_icon_binary_file falls back to legacy behavior.

Finally the DEL_HS20_ICON command deletes (all) icons associated with
BSSID and file-name (there could be several if retries are used and they
have different dialog tokens).

Signed-off-by: Jan Nordqvist <jannq@google.com>
2015-12-19 18:34:01 +02:00
Dmitry Shmidt
96e8d831a5 wpa_supplicant: Add SIGNAL_MONITOR command
SIGNAL_MONITOR THRESHOLD=DD HYSTERESIS=DD command will request signal
strength monitoring events based on there having been requested amount
of drop in the signal strength. The threshold value is the RSSI
threshold in dBm for the event to be sent. 0 threshold can be used to
disable monitoring. The hysteresis value is RSSI hysteresis in dB to
specify the minimum amount of change before a consecutive event is
reported.

With nl80211 driver interface, these values map to the
NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM command with NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD and
NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST attributes to the driver.

This command cannot be used when bgscan module is in use since that
depends on being able to control the connection monitoring parameters.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2015-12-18 21:02:37 +02:00
Matti Gottlieb
2c0d0ae370 GAS: End remain-on-channel due to delayed GAS comeback request
During the sequence of exchanging GAS frames with the AP, the AP can
request to come back in X amount of time and resend the GAS request.

Previously, wpa_supplicant did not terminate the remain-on-channel
session, but rather waited until the requested comeback delay had
expired, and then tried to send the GAS frame (potentially to save the
time that is required to schedule a new remain on channel flow).

This might cause unnecessary idle time (can be close to 1000 ms) in
which the device might be off-channel. Ending the current
remain-on-channel session and then rescheduling makes better usage of
the time in this case.

End remain-on-channel session due to receiving a delayed GAS comeback
request from the AP.

Signed-off-by: Matti Gottlieb <matti.gottlieb@intel.com>
2015-12-18 20:32:53 +02:00
Eliad Peller
685ea2f60c wpa_cli: Send ALL_STA command to the correct interface
wpa_ctrl_command_sta(), called by the "ALL_STA" handler, didn't consider
ifname_prefix, resulting in various commands being sent to the global
control interface, rather than the specified interface when IFNAME=
prefix was used.

This in turn caused the unexpected "UNKNOWN COMMAND" result be
considered as valid station, resulting in infinite loop while trying to
get all stations.

Fix it by considering ifname_prefix, similarly to _wpa_ctrl_command().

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-12-18 00:24:52 +02:00
Ayala Beker
0e6a2cf282 Disconnect before trying to switch to a different network
Previously, when wpa_supplicant received bgscan results with a preferred
network, it connected to that network without disconnecting from the
previous one. This might result in an inconsistent state of upper
layers.

Fix this by disconnecting from the current AP before connecting to the
new one when the network profile changes and there is an existing
connection.

Signed-off-by: Ayala Beker <ayala.beker@intel.com>
2015-12-18 00:24:52 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
706e11a485 Avoid network selection from scan during connection
If scan results arrive during the connection process, the network
selection function was called, interrupting the current connection.
While a regular scan is mutually exclusive with connection establishment
via the nature of radio work, there's no such protection for scheduled
scan. Prevent network selection while a connection is in progress.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-12-18 00:24:52 +02:00
Ayala Beker
1b3dd69d93 P2P: Fix possible NULL pointer dereference
Fix wpas_p2p_invite() to call p2p_set_own_pref_freq_list() after the
NULL check, to avoid NULL pointer dereference if P2P initialization were
to have failed or P2P module getting deinitialized.

Signed-off-by: Ayala Beker <ayala.beker@intel.com>
2015-12-18 00:24:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d06a35052f mesh: Fix VHT Operation information in peering messages
The full VHT channel information was not set in the hostapd data
structures which resulted in incorrect information (all zeros) being
used when building the VHT Operation element for peering messages while
the actual driver mode was set with the full details. We did not seem to
use the VHT information from peering messages, so this does not change
behavior with another wpa_supplicant-based mesh implementation. Anyway,
these elements should match the ones used in Beacon frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-17 21:20:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d560288a44 TLS: Parse CertificateStatus message
This allows the internal TLS client implementation to accept
CertificateStatus message from the server when trying to use OCSP
stapling. The actual OCSPResponse is not yet processed in this commit,
but the CertificateStatus message is accepted to allow the TLS handshake
to continue.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-14 15:49:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3c108b7573 EAP peer: External server certificate chain validation
This adds support for optional functionality to validate server
certificate chain in TLS-based EAP methods in an external program.
wpa_supplicant control interface is used to indicate when such
validation is needed and what the result of the external validation is.

This external validation can extend or replace the internal validation.
When ca_cert or ca_path parameter is set, the internal validation is
used. If these parameters are omitted, only the external validation is
used. It needs to be understood that leaving those parameters out will
disable most of the validation steps done with the TLS library and that
configuration is not really recommend.

By default, the external validation is not used. It can be enabled by
addingtls_ext_cert_check=1 into the network profile phase1 parameter.
When enabled, external validation is required through the CTRL-REQ/RSP
mechanism similarly to other EAP authentication parameters through the
control interface.

The request to perform external validation is indicated by the following
event:
CTRL-REQ-EXT_CERT_CHECK-<id>:External server certificate validation needed for SSID <ssid>

Before that event, the server certificate chain is provided with the
CTRL-EVENT-EAP-PEER-CERT events that include the cert=<hexdump>
parameter. depth=# indicates which certificate is in question (0 for the
server certificate, 1 for its issues, and so on).

The result of the external validation is provided with the following
command:
CTRL-RSP-EXT_CERT_CHECK-<id>:<good|bad>

It should be noted that this is currently enabled only for OpenSSL (and
BoringSSL/LibreSSL). Due to the constraints in the library API, the
validation result from external processing cannot be reported cleanly
with TLS alert. In other words, if the external validation reject the
server certificate chain, the pending TLS handshake is terminated
without sending more messages to the server.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-12 18:24:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
651c6a84af Add TEST_ASSOC_IE for WPA/RSN IE testing on AP side
The new wpa_supplicant control interface command "TEST_ASSOC_IE
<hexdump>" can now be used to override the WPA/RSN IE for Association
Request frame and following 4-way handshake to allow protocol testing of
AP side processing of WPA/RSN IE.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-06 19:33:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
58059e6c0c FST: Print debug entry on MB IE update based on EVENT_AUTH
This is more consistent with all the other callers of
wpas_fst_update_mbie().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-06 12:53:24 +02:00
Avichal Agarwal
af041f997d dbus: Add support for vendor specific elements
The new methods are
1. VendorElemAdd "i" "ay" i=integer ay=array of bytes
2. VendorElemGet "i" i=integer (output array of bytes)
3. VendorElemRem "i" "ay" i=integer ay=array of bytes

These provide functionality similar to the control interface commands
VENDOR_ELEM_ADD, VENDOR_ELEM_GET, and VENDOR_ELEM_REMOVE.

Signed-off-by: Avichal Agarwal <avichal.a@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Kyeong-Chae Lim <kcya.lim@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Dilshad Ahmad <dilshad.a@samsung.com>
[VendorElemGet to return array of bytes instead of string; cleanup]
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-06 12:50:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bf3214b593 P2P: Fix re-invoked client interface completion on data connection
This was already working for the case where a separate group interface
is used due to the recent commit
328f49acfe ('P2P: Complete group formation
on client data connection'). However, the case of no separate group
interface was used did not clear the interface state properly on data
connection. Fix this by setting the group formation information in
wpas_start_p2p_client().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-04 23:11:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
63502c64e1 P2P: Fix P2P_CANCEL for p2p_in_invitation case
Commit f05cee9714 ('P2P: Clear
p2p_in_invitation on cancel') added a wpas_p2p_cancel() case to call
wpas_p2p_group_formation_failed() if wpa_s->p2p_in_invitation is set.
This is done in a loop going through wpa_s->next pointers. However, the
call here can result in removing the interface and freeing wpa_s. The
following attempt to read wpa_s->next is from freed memory and that can
result in process termination when using a separate P2P group interface
and issuing P2P_CANCEL on a group that was started through re-invocation
of a persistent group.

The recent commit 328f49acfe ('P2P:
Complete group formation on client data connection') "fixed" this by
accident since wpa_s->p2p_in_invitation gets cleared in the sequence
that could hit this issue and this results in P2P_CANCEL getting
rejected. However, the real bug here is in the loop that continues after
possible wpa_s instance deletion. Fix that by breaking out of the loop.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-04 22:49:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
213e158ca8 BoringSSL: Move OCSP implementation into a separate file
This makes it easier to share the OCSP implementation needed for
BoringSSL outside tls_openssl.c. For now, this is mainly for
http_curl.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-04 20:08:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
328f49acfe P2P: Complete group formation on client data connection
This was already the case in the GO role where the first client
connection is waited before marking
wpa_s->p2p_go_group_formation_completed = 1 and clearing
wpa_s->global->p2p_group_formation. However, in the P2P Client role,
that was done already at the completion of the WPS exchange. This can be
problematic since group formation timeout may still try to clear the
group and with wpa_s->global->p2p_group_formation == NULL, the correct
group interface may not be found.

Fix this by postponing clearing of wpa_s->global->p2p_group_formation on
the P2P Client side until the data connection has been completed and
group is declared started.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-30 21:35:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bea48f7784 Allow sched_scan_plans to be updated at runtime
This allows the control interface SET command to be used to update the
sched_scan_plans parameter at runtime. In addition, an empty string can
be used to clear the previously configured plan.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-30 14:03:28 +02:00
Avraham Stern
32c02261dd Add support for configuring scheduled scan plans
Add the option to configure scheduled scan plans in the config file.
Each scan plan specifies the interval between scans and the number
of scan iterations. The last plan will run infinitely and thus
specifies only the interval between scan iterations.

usage:
sched_scan_plans=<interval:iterations> <interval2:iterations2> ... <interval>

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-30 14:03:28 +02:00
Avraham Stern
09ea4309b6 nl80211: Add support for multiple scan plans for scheduled scan
Add 'scan plans' to driver scan parameters for scheduled scan.
Each 'scan plan' specifies the number of iterations to run the scan
request and the interval between iterations. When a scan plan
finishes (i.e., it was run for the specified number of iterations),
the next scan plan is executed. The last scan plan will run
infinitely.

The maximum number of supported scan plans, the maximum number of
iterations for a single scan plan and the maximum scan interval
are advertised by the driver.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-30 14:03:28 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dd895e9964 P2P: Make p2p_go_configured() more robust against unexpected calls
A hwsim test sequence was able to hit a SIGSEGV in
p2p_go_save_group_common_freqs() called by p2p_go_configured() callback
in a case where a non-P2P AP mode operation is started in wpa_supplicant
(wpas_ap_wep test case). This callback should not have happened for
non-P2P case and the debug logs did not make it clear how this could
happen. In addition, it is unclear how this could be reproduced.

To avoid this type of issues, clear the wpa_s->ap_configured_cb pointer
as soon as the first call to the function happens. In addition, verify
that wpa_s->go_params is available before processing the GO configured
callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-30 01:25:24 +02:00
Pali Rohár
6bb6a9ce29 Add SHA384 and SHA512 implementations from LibTomCrypt library
These will be used with the internal TLS implementation to extend hash
algorithm support for new certificates and TLS v1.2.

Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali.rohar@gmail.com>
2015-11-29 18:19:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
53401e919e Abort ongoing scans on FLUSH command
This may speed up some hwsim test case sequencies by avoiding a wait for
a scan at the end of a test case to complete.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-27 01:09:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2ea2166d5a Add control interface command for aborting an ongoing scan
The new ABORT_SCAN command can be used to request an ongoing scan to be
aborted.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-26 19:44:14 +02:00
Kanchanapally, Vidyullatha
4ead7cfd5d Abort an ongoing scan before connect
Connect radio work is sometimes delayed for a considerable duration if
there is an ongoing scan radio work. To avoid these delays abort the
ongoing scan on that interface before queuing a connect request. Upon a
scan done indication from the driver, connect radio work will be
scheduled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-26 19:44:14 +02:00
Kanchanapally, Vidyullatha
4f30addb38 nl80211: Add support for aborting an ongoing scan
This adds the driver interface commands for issuing a request to abort
an ongoing scan operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-26 19:44:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0530eb1086 mesh: Clear wpa_s cipher selection on starting mesh
This is needed to avoid hitting WEP/TKIP detection in
ibss_mesh_setup_freq() if the previous connection used WEP or TKIP.
Previously, that could have resulted in VHT and HT getting disabled for
the mesh connection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-26 18:47:40 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
0f29bc68d1 IBSS/mesh: Add support for VHT80P80 configuration
A new network profile configuration parameter max_oper_chwidth=3 can be
used to specify preference to enable 80+80 MHz VHT channel for IBSS. If
that is set, the first 80 MHz segment is specified based on the
frequency parameter in the network profile and the second segment is
selected automatically (which will practically be limited to a single
possibility due to DFS requirements in most countries).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-26 17:47:15 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
c27f4c9006 P2P: Add support for VHT 80+80 MHz and 160 MHz
The new max_oper_chwidth and freq2 arguments to P2P_CONNECT, P2P_INVITE,
and P2P_GROUP_ADD control interface commands can be used to request
larger VHT operating channel bandwidth to be used than the previously
used maximum 80 MHz.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-25 19:01:20 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
bee5d8e067 nl80211: Add VHT 160 MHz channel flags
This extends the previous design that covered only the VHT 80 MHz cases
for VHT channel flags. New functions are introduced to allow 160 MHz
bandwidth cases to determine the center channel and check availability
of a 160 MHz channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-25 19:01:14 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
5e1da9c8fd P2P: Define operating classes for VHT 80+80 and 160
This adds definitions for the global operating classes 129 and 130 for
VHT 80+80 MHz and 160 MHz use cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-25 19:01:10 +02:00
Dedy Lansky
ea7081185e FST: Improve parsing of Multiband IEs
Previously, MB IEs were parsed only from association event. Try to get
MB IEs from other management frames like Probe Response frames. The MB
IEs from the association event may not be up-to-date and in some cases
may actually be missing and updating the information based on other
frames can improve robustness of FST exchanges.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-25 17:33:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
39c3c9b7dc Remove wpa_supplicant/tests
There was only a single file remaining in this directory. All the other
old test functionality has been moved under the top level tests
directory. Move the remaining file to the wpa_supplicant directory to
get rid of the subdirectory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-24 00:00:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1fff13a9cb tests: Move EAP-SIM PRF module test into the hwsim framework
The old wpa_supplicant/Makefile target test-eap_sim_common did not work
anymore and anyway, this test is better placed in the newer hwsim
framework to make sure the test case gets executed automatically.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-24 00:00:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9b635d0bde Remove link_test and test_wpa
These wpa_supplicant test programs have not been maintained for years
and it would take significant effort to get these into working state.
Since there does not seem to be any real need for these based on lack of
maintenance, it is easier to just drop these tools for now.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-24 00:00:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9e68742ef1 Fix CONFIG_NO_WPA=y build
Number of places were calling functions that are not included in
CONFIG_NO_WPA=y build anymore. Comment out such calls. In addition, pull
in SHA1 and MD5 for config_internal.c, if needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-23 23:34:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
eb926f1257 Comment out wpas_reenabled_network_time with CONFIG_NO_SCAN_PROCESSING
This removes a compiler warning about unused function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-23 23:33:55 +02:00
Ilan Peer
ed7820b484 P2P: Add a testing option to force P2P GO CSA
Add a testing option to force a P2P GO CSA on successful
invitation to join an active P2P GO.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-11-22 21:49:19 +02:00
Ilan Peer
6cbbae2cf8 P2P: Set p2p_go_wait_client in invitation_result() cb
When an invitation to join an existing group is accepted by the
peer device, set p2p_go_wait_client to the current time so
that wpas_p2p_in_progress() would return != 0, thus preventing
P2P CSA, scanning etc., that would interfere with the peer
device connection.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-11-22 21:46:43 +02:00
Avraham Stern
cadffacb3f wpa_cli: Add an option to set created interface type
Add an option to set the interface type when creating
a driver interface.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-22 17:50:05 +02:00
Avraham Stern
0f039e3432 Add an option to create interface of a certain type with INTERFACE_ADD
Some drivers do not support having two station interfaces, so the fact
that wpa_supplicant always creates a new interface in station mode, even
if it will be used as another type of interface, may prevent
wpa_supplicant from creating new interfaces. Allow setting the interface
type when a new interface is created so that interfaces of supported
types can be created.

Currently supported types are station ("sta") and AP ("ap"). If the
interface type is not specified, a station interface will be created.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-22 17:46:54 +02:00
Avraham Stern
d8a3b66d7f driver: Make setting up AP optional when creating AP interface
When an AP interface it created, it is also setup and subscribes
for management frames etc. However, when the interface is added by
wpa_supplicant, setting up for AP operations is redundant because
it will be done by wpa_supplicant on wpa_drv_init() when setting
the interface mode to AP.

In addition, it may cause wpa_supplicant to fail initializing the
interface as it will try to subscribe for management frames on this
interface but the interface is already registered.

Change this, so when adding an AP interface, make setting up the AP
optional, and use it only when the interface is added by hostapd but not
when it is added by wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-22 17:42:59 +02:00
Avraham Stern
2c51c0bd83 P2P: Clear send action work without waiting on find/stop/listen
When clearing pending TX action to start a new P2P operation like
P2P_FIND or P2P_LISTEN, wpas_p2p_action_tx_clear() was used to clear
the send action work. However, in cases where the action work has wait
time, it is not cleared immediately but only after the wait time ends.
This may cause delay in starting the P2P operation.

Fix that by always clearing the send action work immediately on these
P2P commands that result in immediate P2P state change and practically
stopping a previous operation, if one was pending.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-21 18:53:22 +02:00
Ravi Joshi
f32227ed9e Add QCA vendor attribute and event to indicate subnet change status
This allows offloaded roaming to inform user space of the change in IP
subnet post roaming. The device may have roamed to a network which is in
a different subnet which will result in IP connectivity loss. Indicating
the change in subnet enables the user space to refresh the IP address or
to perform IP subnet validation if unknown status is indicated.

The driver indication is reported with a new event from wpa_supplicant
in the following format:
CTRL-EVENT-SUBNET-STATUS-UPDATE status=<0/1/2>
where
0 = unknown
1 = IP subnet unchanged (can continue to use the old IP address)
2 = IP subnet changed (need to get a new IP address)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-20 11:03:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d38c7be0f0 Skip SELECT_NETWORK steps only if already connected or connecting
Commit 2a6f78fbbe ('Do not re-associate on
SELECT_NETWORK to current network') started skipping all SELECT_NETWORK
connection steps if the selected network had already been selected
previously. This happened regardless of whether the connection was
already established. This is not necessarily desirable for all cases
where there is no immediate action to even try to connect (e.g., long
wait for the next scan).

Speed this up by allowing the SELECT_NETWORK operation to get started if
there is no connection or ongoing connection attempt with the selected
network.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-20 00:45:40 +02:00
Peter Oh
a65efbfb24 Add VHT support for Mesh
Mesh Points themselves have capability to support VHT as long as
hardware supports it. However, supporting VHT in mesh mode was disabled
because no one had clearly tested and confirmed its functionality. Since
VHT80 has now been verified to work with ath10k QCA988X driver and
mac80211_hwsim, enable VHT support in mesh mode.

Signed-off-by: Peter Oh <poh@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-19 11:37:41 +02:00
Peter Oh
a73c984261 Set WMM flag to Mesh STA by default
Set WLAN_STA_WMM flag to Mesh STA by default since Mesh STAs are QoS
STAs. Mesh STA's HT capabilities won't be parsed properly without the
flag.

Signed-off-by: Peter Oh <poh@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-19 11:37:17 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
5e238cc682 WPS: Reconnect for a failed data connection when STA_AUTOCONNECT is 0
If "STA_AUTOCONNECT 0" has been used to disable automatic connection on
disconnection event and the driver indicates a failure for the data
connection after successful WPS handshake, it is possible to hit a case
where wpa_s->disconnected is set to 1 and further attempts to connect
shall stop.

While "STA_AUTOCONNECT 0" is used to disable automatic reconnection
attempts in general, this specific WPS case can benefit from trying
again even with that configuration for a short period of time. Extend
the wpa_supplicant re-enable-networks-after-WPS 10 second timeout to
apply for ignoring disabled STA_AUTOCONNECT immediately after a WPS
provisioning step.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-17 19:50:34 +02:00
MAYANK HAARIT
442cc8cc41 dbus: Fix memory leak in sending InvitationReceived signal
Free the message after message send in
wpas_dbus_signal_p2p_invitation_received() to avoid leaking memory.

Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Avichal Agarwal <avichal.a@samsung.com>
2015-11-17 17:20:03 +02:00
Samuel Tan
07e3653922 dbus: Do not use pointer arithmetic with a void pointer
This failed to compile on x86 gcc due to pointer arithmetic on a void
pointer.

Signed-off-by: Samuel Tan <samueltan@google.com>
2015-11-15 19:34:51 +02:00
Samuel Tan
3b49719130 Android: Use libdbus rather than dbus-1
The upstream wpa_supplicant uses the dbus-1 library when it is compiled
with D-Bus support. In Android, we imported the D-Bus shared libraries
under the name "libdbus", so use this shared library instead of dbus-1
when compiling wpa_supplicant with D-Bus support.

Signed-off-by: Samuel Tan <samueltan@google.com>
2015-11-15 19:26:49 +02:00
Ben Greear
5b75ecead3 Document passive_scan option for wpa_supplicant.conf
This should save the next person to need this behavior some time.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-11-15 19:25:05 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
2d0fe6bc4e dbus: Add SaveConfig to update configuration file
This is similar to SAVE_CONFIG on control interface, which allow users
to update the configuration file.

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
2015-11-15 19:04:15 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
fb7e7daeff dbus: Fix a copy-paste error in debug print
Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
2015-11-15 18:53:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
03ed0a5239 WNM: Ignore WNM-Sleep Mode Response if WNM-Sleep Mode has not been used
The AP is not expected to send out a WNM-Sleep Mode Response frame
without the STA trying to use WNM-Sleep Mode. Drop such unexpected
responses to reduce unnecessary processing of the frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-10 18:40:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2cb28a4c75 WNM: Ignore Key Data in WNM Sleep Mode Response frame if no PMF in use
WNM Sleep Mode Response frame is used to update GTK/IGTK only if PMF is
enabled. Verify that PMF is in use before using this field on station
side to avoid accepting unauthenticated key updates. (CVE-2015-5310)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-10 18:40:54 +02:00
Max Stepanov
73ed03f333 wpa_supplicant: Add GTK RSC relaxation workaround
Some APs may send RSC octets in EAPOL-Key message 3 of 4-Way Handshake
or in EAPOL-Key message 1 of Group Key Handshake in the opposite byte
order (or by some other corrupted way). Thus, after a successful
EAPOL-Key exchange the TSC values of received multicast packets, such as
DHCP, don't match the RSC one and as a result these packets are dropped
on replay attack TSC verification. An example of such AP is Sapido
RB-1732.

Work around this by setting RSC octets to 0 on GTK installation if the
AP RSC value is identified as a potentially having the byte order issue.
This may open a short window during which older (but valid)
group-addressed frames could be replayed. However, the local receive
counter will be updated on the first received group-addressed frame and
the workaround is enabled only if the common invalid cases are detected,
so this workaround is acceptable as not decreasing security
significantly. The wpa_rsc_relaxation global configuration property
allows the GTK RSC workaround to be disabled if it's not needed.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-11-01 21:00:22 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ea6030c77f Restore previous wpa_state in scan-only result handler
The SCAN TYPE=ONLY results do not trigger a connection operation
automatically. As such, there was no explicit operation that would
change wpa_state after such a scan-only operation and WPA_SCANNING state
could have been left in effect until the next operation is triggered by
an external command. This is not desirable, so restore the wpa_state
that was in use when the scan was started in case WPA_SCANNING state is
still set when the scan operation completes.

This was triggered by the following mac80211_hwsim test sequence:
dbus_wps_oom scan_trigger_failure

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-01 20:26:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1e74ae4de9 WNM: Clear BSS TM data if already associated with preferred candidate
Previously, wnm_deallocate_memory() was called only if we decided to
move to another BSS at the completion of an accepted BSS Transition
Management Request. This resulted in the candidate information being
left in effect for the following scan operation if we were already
associated with the preferred candidate. This could result in unexpected
behavior in the following connection attempt.

Fix this by clearing the candidate information even if we do not need to
roam to another BSS.

This was triggered with mac80211_hwsim test cases in this sequence:
wnm_bss_tm ap_track_sta_force_2ghz

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-01 20:09:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a34eace204 dbus: Remove unused dict helper functions
There are no callers for these helper functions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-11-01 00:16:57 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
cdcb2d0e7f wpa_cli: Add support for vendor_elem_* commands
Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Avichal Agarwal <avichal.a@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
2015-10-31 21:56:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1f1e619282 Add test programs for checking libwpa_client linking
libwpa_test1 and libwpa_test2 targets can now be used to check
libwpa_client linking for static and shared library cases respectively.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-31 21:56:59 +02:00
Jörg Krause
736b7cb2da wpa_supplicant/Makefile: Fix libwpa_client build
Building libwpa_client requires src/utils/common.c for bin_clear_free()
else loading the library fails with:

Error relocating /usr/lib/libwpa_client.so: bin_clear_free: symbol not found

Signed-off-by: Jörg Krause <joerg.krause@embedded.rocks>
2015-10-31 19:15:37 +02:00
Dan Williams
e50c50d5a0 dbus: Expose interface globals via D-Bus properties
All interface globals are now exposed as D-Bus properties of type
string, and parsed via the normal interface global parsing functions.

Signed-off-by: Dan Williams <dcbw@redhat.com>
2015-10-28 23:41:32 +02:00
Dan Williams
1aa0fb77ea dbus: Pass property description to getters/setters
We'll use it later for global interface properties.

Signed-off-by: Dan Williams <dcbw@redhat.com>
2015-10-28 23:40:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8f3ea3175f tests: Fix build without CONFIG_ERP=y
hmac_sha256_kdf() got pulled in only if CONFIG_ERP=y is set. Fix
test_sha256() by making the test case conditional on the function being
present.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-26 00:42:14 +02:00
Lubomir Rintel
1248e58492 wpa_supplicant: Reopen debug log file upon receipt of SIGHUP signal
This is useful for logrotate to be able to rotate the file even if the
control interface is not enabled (e.g., when using DBus).

Signed-off-by: Lubomir Rintel <lkundrak@v3.sk>
2015-10-25 20:45:02 +02:00
Mohammed Shafi Shajakhan
67deaa582d l2_packet: Add build option to disable Linux packet socket workaround
Linux packet socket workaround(*) has an impact in performance when the
workaround socket needs to be kept open to receive EAPOL frames. While
this is normally avoided with a kernel that has the issue addressed by
closing the workaround packet socket when detecting a frame through the
main socket, it is possible for that mechanism to not be sufficient,
e.g., when an open network connection (no EAPOL frames) is used.

Add a build option (CONFIG_NO_LINUX_PACKET_SOCKET_WAR=y) to disable the
workaround. This build option is disabled by default and can be enabled
explicitly on distributions which have an older kernel or a fix for the
kernel regression.

Also remove the unused variable num_rx.

(*) Linux kernel commit 576eb62598f10c8c7fd75703fe89010cdcfff596
('bridge: respect RFC2863 operational state') from 2012 introduced a
regression for using wpa_supplicant with EAPOL frames and a station
interface in a bridge.

Signed-off-by: Mohammed Shafi Shajakhan <mohammed@qti.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-25 19:56:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fa46426725 RSN: Do not try to connect if PMF disabled and AP requires it
Instead of trying to associate in configuration that is known to result
in the AP rejecting the association, reject the BSS candidate based on
the MFPR=1 RSN capability when STA configuration has PMF disabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 19:37:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8acbe7f2a4 WNM: Verify WNM Sleep Mode element length
This element is required to have at least four octets of actual payload.
This was not previously verified before use and the extra buffer data
after the IE might have been used instead if a received WNM-Sleep Mode
Response frame was invalid.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 19:37:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dacd789f6d WNM: Mark set TFS buffer const
This moves the type cast needed for the current driver interface to
ieee802_11_set_tfs_ie() to allow the WNM-Sleep parsing routines to use
const pointers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 19:37:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f758ae7665 P2P SD: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
619fdfacc4 HS 2.0: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
904e977bc7 Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic in scan result IE parsing
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bdce45b83e WNM: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1f32a23962 Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic in BSS IE parsing
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-24 21:43:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
67fea55ca2 Interworking: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-24 21:43:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ca33a5e895 Add "git describe" based version string postfix
If hostapd or wpa_supplicant is built from a git repository, add a
VERSION_STR postfix from the current git branch state. This is from "git
describe --dirty=+". VERSION_STR will thus look something like
"2.6-devel-hostap_2_5-132-g4363c0d+" for development builds from a
modified repository.

This behavior is enabled automatically if a build within git repository
is detected (based on ../.git existing). This can be disabled with
CONFIG_NO_GITVER=y in wpa_supplicant/.config and hostapd/.config.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-16 22:20:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4363c0d6f5 eapol_test: Add -v for displaying version information
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-16 22:00:11 +03:00
Avraham Stern
932267ad67 P2P: Add P2P_ASSOC_RESP to P2P vendor elements
Vendor specific IEs added to frame type P2P_ASSOC_RESP are saved in
the interface context, but as they are added as part of the P2P IEs,
they need to be saved in the global P2P context.

Fix this by directing vendor specific IEs added to P2P_ASSOC_RESP
frame type to the P2P context.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-10-16 20:47:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e699a7a9b3 P2P: Add more debug prints for Action frame TX clearing steps
This makes it easier to analyze debug logs for issues related to
multiple pending Action TX frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-15 21:20:22 +03:00
Avraham Stern
1a21fd37f9 Do not expire scan results based on aborted scan
Do not expire scan results entries based on scan results from a scan
that was aborted. The aborted scan did not scan all the requested
channels or SSIDs, so the fact that a BSS is missing from the scan
results does not mean it is not available.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-10-14 21:12:28 +03:00
Avraham Stern
0aed3f5a80 P2P: Set CTWindow only for P2P GO
CTWindow was set for all AP interfaces if the driver supports it and
this parameter is set in wpa_supplicant configuration. This results in
failing to start an AP that is not a P2P GO as this setting is rejected
by the driver.

Fix that by setting the CTWindow only for P2P GO interface.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-10-14 21:09:41 +03:00
Ningyuan Wang
c143c3b72a D-Bus: Add a dbus handler for expected disconnection
Add a global D-Bus handler ExpectDisconnect for setting
wpa_s->own_disconnect_req flag. This flag will prevent wpa_supplicant
from adding blacklists and requesting incomplete scan upon the incoming
disconnection. This is mainly meant for a case where suspend/resume is
used and some external component knows about that and can provide the
information to wpa_supplicant before the disconnection happens.

Signed-off-by: Ningyuan Wang <nywang@google.com>
2015-10-12 18:03:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a8412ec9d0 Clear own_disconnect_req on new connection attempt
It was possible for wpa_s->own_disconnect_req to be left set to 1 from a
disconnection attempt from a prior connection. This could then prevent
proper connection failure processing with the new connection in
wpas_connection_failed(). This was triggered by the following hwsim test
case sequence: wpas_mesh_secure sae_no_ffc_by_default. In this sequence,
the SAE failure due to unsupported group did not result in proper
wpas_connection_failed() processing and retry.

Fix this by clearing wpa_s->own_disconnect_req in
wpa_supplicant_associate() before starting a new connection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-12 14:24:06 +03:00
Max Stepanov
cd571e14dd P2PS: Fix persistent group reporting in wpas_p2ps_prov_complete()
When one peer doesn't include a persistent group info in PD Request
the other peer shouldn't report a persistent group usage with this
peer even if such a persistent group exists locally. This condition
could be violated in the previous implementation.

In case a local persistent group exists and the
wpas_p2ps_prov_complete() function is called with persist_ssid parameter
set to NULL, wpa_supplicant reported P2PS-PROV-DONE with persist=<idx>
instead of conncap=<role> parameter.

This happened because the wpas_p2p_get_persistent() function was called
without verification whether the persist_ssid was set to NULL. In this
case the wpas_p2p_get_persistent() returns the first existing persistent
group matching the P2P Device Address without verifying the group's
SSID. After that the group ID is used as persist=<idx> parameter of
P2PS-PROV-DONE event.

Fix the issue by adding persist_ssid and persist_ssid_size verification
as a condition for the wpas_p2p_get_persistent() call.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-10-11 21:42:03 +03:00
Ilan Peer
8bb8e6edb8 P2PS: Indicate the chosen operating frequency
On successful P2P PD, report the chosen frequency in case the local
device is going to be the P2P GO, so in can later be used to instantiate
the new P2P GO, etc.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-11 21:42:03 +03:00
Ilan Peer
ebd32943cb P2PS: Add channel policy to PD Request
Add operating channel selection and channel list processing similar to
that done when building GO Negotiation Request, i.e., consider the
currently used channels, configured channels, etc.

P2PS introduces a flow where a responder needs to provide channel data
without being previously aware of the current constraints, i.e., the
channels currently in use by other interfaces. To handle this, extend
the get_group_capability() callback to also handle channel selection
aspects of group capabilities.

In case there is an active P2P GO that is going to be used for the P2PS
PD, force its current operating frequency in the PD attributes.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-11 21:42:03 +03:00
Ilan Peer
f8a80e39b3 P2PS: Change connection capability handling
Change the connection capability handling so that in case there are no
active roles, the peer has an active GO, and the advertisement supports
operation as a client, the returned connection capability is set to
client.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-07 17:07:21 +03:00
Ilan Peer
ab804bcb6f P2PS: Re-factor p2ps_group_capability()
The code was iterating all the interfaces, and for each interface
iterated all the network blocks to count active P2P GO and P2P Client
interfaces.

Change the code to reuse wpas_p2p_get_go_group() to get a P2P GO
interface and add wpas_p2p_get_cli_group() and use it to find a
P2P Client interface, and use these objects when evaluating the
group capability.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-07 17:07:21 +03:00
Ilan Peer
8d5e73290f P2PS: Re-factor wpas_p2p_get_go_group() and wpas_p2p_group_go_ssid()
Re-factor wpas_p2p_get_go_group() to:

1. Skip the dedicated P2P Device management interface if it is used.
2. Instead of iterating all the interface configured networks,
   only access the current_ssid pointer to check if the current
   interface is acting as a persistent P2P GO.

To avoid code duplication, also re-factor wpas_p2p_group_go_ssid()
to call wpas_p2p_get_go_group().

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-07 17:07:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
876e74aa5f Interworking: Fix wpa_supplicant build without CONFIG_HS20=y
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-07 17:07:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8c4a1026b8 Interworking: Support unknown ANQP-elements in BSS table
This allows wpa_supplicant to expose internally unknown ANQP-elements in
the BSS command. For example, "ANQP_GET <BSSID> 265" can be used to
fetch the AP Geospatial Location ANQP-element and if the AP has this
information, the "BSS <BSSID>" command will include the response as
"anqp[265]=<hexdump>".

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-07 17:07:21 +03:00
Adam Langley
aeeb0bca71 Android: Fix keystore-backed keys with BoringSSL
The switch to BoringSSL broke keystore-backed keys because
wpa_supplicant was using the dynamic ENGINE loading to load
the keystore module.
The ENGINE-like functionality in BoringSSL is much simpler
and this change should enable it.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2015-10-06 23:10:17 +03:00
Bob Copeland
681753f23c mesh: Generate proper AID for peer
IEEE Std 802.11-2012 13.3.1 states that the AID should be generated on
the local node for each peer. Previously, we were using the peer link ID
(generated by the peer) which may not be unique among all peers. Correct
this by reusing the AP AID generation code.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-10-06 01:27:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
12ea4cff6b Add forgotten list entry removal for control interface deinit
dl_list_del() must be called before freeing the list entries. Neither of
these cases caused problems because the full list data structure was
freed, but still, it is better to do this properly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-04 18:52:38 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3fdaaa8fc4 Throttle control interface event message bursts
Some operations like a new scan result processing can result in large
number of wpa_supplicant control interface messages being generated.
Especially with multiple control interface monitors, this could result
in hitting the output queue length maximum and event messages getting
dropped. In worst case, that could even result in hitting ten
consecutive sendto() errors which could result in an attached monitor
socket getting detached.

Avoid this type of issues by throttling monitor event transmission based
on the output queue length. If more than half of the maximum send buffer
is used, postpone sending of following event messages until the pending
output queue has dropped below the limit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-04 18:52:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a530fe778b Add wpa_supplicant EVENT_TEST control interface command
This testing command makes it easier to debug bursts of event message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-04 11:45:13 +03:00
Luciano Coelho
7d82170aba Set channel and operating class in hostapd_fill_csa_settings()
The CSA channel and operating class values need to be set for all types
of channel switch (i.e., either if it's triggered by the control
interfaces or due to the GO-follows-STA flow). To do so, move the code
that sets them from the GO-follows-STA flow to the more generic
hostapd_fill_csa_settings() function.

Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
2015-10-03 21:26:23 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
2d3943ce5b nl80211: Specify CSA offsets in send_mlme() driver op
Some management frames contain CSA counters which should be updated by
kernel. Change driver op send_mlme() allowing to send a frame,
specifying an array of offsets to the CSA counters which should be
updated. For example, CSA offsets parameters should be specified when
sending Probe Response frames during CSA period.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-10-03 21:07:35 +03:00
Ilan Peer
61f121d925 Handle channel switch notification for other interface types
Channel switch notification was handled only for AP/GO interfaces. As
the notification can be sent on other interface types as well, extend
the handling to handle other interface types.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-03 21:01:49 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
98b0508121 P2P: Implement P2P_GO_FREQ_MOVE_SCM_ECSA policy
Add new GO frequency move policy. The P2P_GO_FREQ_MOVE_SCM_ECSA prefers
SCM if all the clients advertise eCSA support and the candidate
frequency is one of the group common frequencies.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-10-03 20:30:40 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
3bafb0d842 P2P: Trigger channel selection correctly during CSA
Do not consider moving GOs to a new channel if one of them is in the
middle of CSA. In addition, call wpas_p2p_update_channel_list() after
EVENT_CH_SWITCH is handled.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-10-03 20:22:09 +03:00
Ilan Peer
23dcb302eb P2P: Relax wpas_p2p_init_go_params() for P2P GO CSA
wpas_p2p_move_go_csa() uses wpas_p2p_init_p2p_params() to select the
frequency to move to. However, it is possible that all the channels are
already used, so the selection of a new frequency would fail, although
the frequency used by the P2P GO should not be considered as used if it
is the only one using it.

To overcome this, allow the frequency selection to continue even if all
the frequencies are in use, but the frequency used by the P2P GO is not
used by any station interface.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-10-03 20:16:51 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
73afc20d40 P2P: Implement wpas_p2p_move_go_csa()
Use channel switch mechanism to move a P2P GO to a new channel,
when required. In order to be able to reconfigure the GO channel,
split wpa_supplicant_conf_ap() function, so the frequency
configuration part can be reused to find additional CSA settings.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-10-03 20:10:37 +03:00
David du Colombier
33bce0e732 wpa_cli: Fix static linking with readline
The readline library depends on ncurses, so it should be set before
ncurses on the linker command line to be able to be statically linked
successfully.

Signed-off-by: David du Colombier <0intro@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
2015-10-01 20:49:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b658547dd5 nl80211: Add build option for QCA vendor extensions
This allows the binary sizes to be reduced if no support for nl80211
vendor extensions are needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-01 12:45:27 +03:00
Kanchanapally, Vidyullatha
e903d32d41 Parallelize distinct radio work operations
This commit contains the necessary changes to parallelize
distinct radio work operations which are different in type and
the band used, only when the underlying driver is capable of
supporting such simultaneous offchannel operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-01 01:41:46 +03:00
Kanchanapally, Vidyullatha
adcd7c4b0b nl80211: Support vendor scan together with normal scan
Allow wpa_supplicant to use vendor scan (if supported by the driver)
together with the normal nl80211 scan and handling external scan events.
Since this results in possibility of concurrent scan operations, some of
the operations related to scan results need to check more carefully when
an event is relevant for a specific interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-01 01:41:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
49c36b708e Add ChangeLog entries for v2.5
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-27 22:02:05 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
be5ab8d4ab D-Bus: Add InvitationReceived Signal
This is equivalent to the P2P_EVENT_INVITATION_RECEIVED signal on the
control interface. It can be used to sent the Invitation Received signal
to applications written using D-Bus.

Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-09-27 15:55:11 +03:00
Saurav Babu
0a7b2a02eb D-Bus: Add Signal to notify WPS PBC Overlap event
Signed-off-by: Saurav Babu <saurav.babu@samsung.com>
2015-09-27 12:52:34 +03:00
Saurav Babu
893e2cf961 D-Bus: Add signal to notify WPS timeout event
Signed-off-by: Saurav Babu <saurav.babu@samsung.com>
2015-09-27 12:47:47 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
55b4cc6dd7 wpa_supplicant: Fix channel switch notification with VHT
Fix a bug in wpas_ap_ch_switch() function, which didn't pass VHT
frequencies correctly to hostapd_event_ch_switch().

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-09-25 21:09:58 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
d7ded54774 Update wpa_s->current_ssid->frequency on CS event
Update wpa_s->current_ssid->frequency when EVENT_CH_SWITCH is received.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-09-25 21:07:01 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
22264b3c61 Fix get_shared_radio_freqs_data() used-by flags setting
Fix an iteration bug in get_shared_radio_freqs_data when building
freqs_data array. Only the last used-by flag was maintained instead of
making this a bitfield of all found uses.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-09-25 21:02:55 +03:00
Masashi Honma
241c33335b mesh: Add support for scanning only the current frequency
This patch enables scan_cur_freq=1 on VIF based mesh network.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-09-25 20:59:32 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
fd7d3c495e D-BUS: dev_passwd_id should be "q" because it uses DBUS_TYPE_UINT16
This corrects the type of dev_passwd_id in GONegotiationRequest event.
This field is packed as DBUS_TYPE_UINT16 but in
wpas_dbus_interface_signals it was "i" which is DBUS_TYPE_INT32.

Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2015-09-25 20:54:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
de78844b33 Fix EAP-EKE peer build rules
NEED_AES_CBC is needed for EAP-EKE builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-25 19:43:44 +03:00
Alan T. DeKok
939471b9eb Linker changes for building eapol_test on OS X
Signed-off-by: Alan DeKok <aland@freeradius.org>
2015-09-25 19:32:14 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
c9cfa6a9af Android: Avoid same per-iface and global ctrl socket
Android platform assigns the same socket id if the socket identifier in
conf->ctrl_interface and global->params.ctrl_interface (parameter for
android_get_control_socket) point to the same Android specific control
socket. This ends up having two eloop socket handlers registered for the
same file descriptor and thus, two attempt to receive and process each
command. This can result in unexpected failure, e.g., the prefix IFNAME=
for any command is valid for global socket handler, but results in
UNKNOWN COMMAND response from the per-interface ctrl socket handler).

Since it might be possible to end up with this type of invalid
configuration in OTA upgrade, compare the socket identifiers and do not
open the ctrl socket on the respective interface if both point to same.
This allows the Wi-Fi framework to use the global control interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-09-24 13:10:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5a1d9d1a8e Avoid reconnection on ENABLE_NETWORK if already connected
This was already the case for most command sequences, but it was
possible for wpa_s->reassociate to be set to 1 when CTRL-RSP-* commands
were used to set identity, password, or passphrase for EAP
authentication. In such cases, ENABLE_NETWORK issued after the
connection was completed could result in a new connection attempt
(likely reconnection back to the same BSS).

Fix this by checking whether an actual connection is already present
even if wpa_s->reassociate is set when processing the ENABLE_NETWORK
command.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-09-22 11:55:54 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
ce7d0eb184 Update AP WPA/RSN IE on all associations if driver can select BSS
It is possible for driver-based BSS selection to end up reassociating
back to the current AP. If wpa_supplicant preferred another BSS, it
would have updated the internal knowledge of the AP's WPA/RSN IE when
requesting a new connection. In the special case of existing association
and new association being with the same BSS that is different from the
wpa_supplicant preference, association event processing skipped the
WPA/RSN IE update. This could result in the following 4-way handshake
getting rejected due to incorrectly detected mismatch with AP's RSN/WPA
IE between Beacon/Probe Response frame and EAPOL-Key msg 3/4.

Fix this by updating the AP WPA/RSN IE on all association events when
driver-based BSS selection is used regardless of whether the BSSID
changes. This could also cover a theoretical case of the AP changing its
RSN/WPA IE at the very moment we try to reassociate back to the same
BSS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-09-17 17:40:40 +07:00
Jouni Malinen
43fa110b0b Drop some control interface debug print verbosity for send operations
These prints were at DEBUG level (-d), but they can be very frequent, so
drop them to MSGDUMP (-dd). This allows the prints to be suppressed in
common debugging cases while still leaving them easily enablable to
debug control interface issues without having to enable excessive
debugging.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-09-10 11:19:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8db9a79d41 Reduce debug verbosity for read-only control interface commands
Commands like BSS and GET_NETWORK are used in some cases very frequently
and those can increase the amount of debug information from
wpa_supplicant without significant benefit. These were logged at the
DEBUG level (-d). Move logging of such read-only commands (i.e., no new
wpa_supplicant operation is started based on it) to EXCESSIVE level
(-ddd) which was already used for the PING command.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-09-10 11:17:19 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
2a95fac944 P2P: Add D-Bus signal GroupFormationFailure
This is similar to the control interface event
P2P-GROUP-FORMATION-FAILURE.

Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2015-09-05 23:01:20 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6f416c7867 RSN IBSS: Fix segfault on error path
If wpa_init() fails, wpa_deinit(NULL) must not be called to avoid
hitting a NULL pointer dereference.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 21:35:16 +03:00
Masashi Honma
449d63d6b7 mesh: Fix memory leak on error path
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-09-05 21:31:25 +03:00
Masashi Honma
a5d2bf2473 mesh: Fix segfault on error path
When wpa_init() in __mesh_rsn_auth_init() failed, empty rsn->auth caused
segmentation fault due to NULL pointer dereference when wpa_deinit() was
called. Fix this by checking the pointer before executing deinit steps.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-09-05 21:31:25 +03:00
Masashi Honma
f029c44cf2 mesh: Add RSN IE to Mesh Peering Open/Confirm frames
The RSN IE is required by IEEE Std 802.11-2012 on SAE use case:
Table 8-262 Mesh Peering Open frame Action field format
Table 8-263 Mesh Peering Confirm frame Action field format

Add the RSN IE to these frames.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-09-05 21:19:25 +03:00
Masashi Honma
8a51dcbc2f mesh: Rename IE field to clarify its use
This is used only for RSNE.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-09-05 21:15:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dcc8bc82e0 Add BSS operating frequency to more debug messages
This makes it easier to analyze debug logs when figuring out channel
related issues.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 20:40:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c4f0c4d67d wpa_gui: Increase control interface message buffer for LIST_NETWORKS
Double the buffer length from 2048 to 4096 to match the length used
currently in wpa_supplicant. This allows wpa_gui to retrieve information
for more networks than previously.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 19:28:56 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ec4387f9c9 Indicate CTRL-EVENT-AUTH-REJECT event on authentication rejection
This allows control interface monitors to get more detailed information
in cases where wpa_supplicant-based SME receives an Authentication frame
with non-zero status code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 19:11:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6ebe816be0 wpa_priv: Add authentication command and event
These are needed to work with nl80211 driver interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 13:21:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
06f52b12f9 wpa_priv: Add support for EVENT_SCAN_STARTED
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 12:39:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d01136a06e wpa_priv: Print unsupported driver event name in debug log
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 12:35:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c968f2d56c wpa_priv: Clear extended_capa pointers
For now, there is no support for passing extended_capa pointers through
the driver_privsep.c interface from wpa_priv. Avoid leaving bogus
pointers by explicitly clearing these on both wpa_priv and
wpa_supplicant sides.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 12:32:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
20396ab8e4 wpa_priv: Add support for global driver interface context
This is needed with driver_nl80211.c to be able to use the newer
wpa_driver_ops::init2() alternative.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 12:03:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
85f4381e14 wpa_priv: allow l2_packet to be opened for ethertype 0x890d
This is needed to initialize TDLS functionality.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 11:54:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bd1f06aaa8 wpa_priv: Add -c argument to usage text
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 11:44:34 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ebf05623c4 wpa_priv: Fix early exit path
eloop_destroy() cannot be called before eloop_init() have been called
successfully.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 11:41:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8406cd3515 Make it clearer that ap_scan=2 mode should not be used with nl80211
Add more details into configuration comments and a runtime info message
if ap_scan=2 is used with the nl80211 driver interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-09-05 01:04:29 +03:00
Manikandan Mohan
4ae7120919 Allow wpa_cli/hostapd_cli client socket directory to be specified
This adds a new helper function wpa_ctrl_open2() that can be used
instead of wpa_ctrl_open() to override the default client socket
directory. Add optional -s<directory path> argument to hostapd_cli and
wpa_cli to allow the client socket directory to be specified.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-09-01 11:17:43 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
fc078be2dd Allow BSS to return information for AP that uses an invalid WSC IE
Previously, the BSS command returned an error if the WSC IE(s) in scan
results could not be parsed. This may be not ideal for all cases, to
instead of rejecting the command completely, return all other
information apart from the WPS information in such a case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-30 00:01:48 +03:00
MAYANK HAARIT
80bb38742c dbus: Fix a typo in function comment
Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Dilshad Ahmad <dilshad.a@samsung.com>
2015-08-28 00:23:23 +03:00
Jiří Klimeš
98da137545 dbus: Do not quote scan_freq and freq_list in dbus_old_handlers.c
scan_freq and freq_list are not parsed correctly by
wpa_config_parse_int_array() if quoted.

Patch for dbus_old_handlers.c, the same change as done by Robert Shade
<robert.shade@gmail.com> for dbus_new_handlers.c in commit
99276998fa ('dbus: Do not quote scan_freq
and freq_list').

Signed-off-by: Jiří Klimeš <jklimes@redhat.com>
2015-08-28 00:13:26 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d9c807cab1 Fix key derivation for Suite B 192-bit AKM to use SHA384
While the EAPOL-Key MIC derivation was already changed from SHA256 to
SHA384 for the Suite B 192-bit AKM, KDF had not been updated similarly.
Fix this by using HMAC-SHA384 instead of HMAC-SHA256 when deriving PTK
from PMK when using the Suite B 192-bit AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-27 20:42:14 +03:00
Mitchell Wills
a218e1ded4 Make sure configuration is saved to storage device
Config file is written to a temp file and then it is renamed to the
original config file. However, it is possible that the rename operation
will be commited to storage while file data will be still in cache
causing original config file to be empty or partially written in case of
a system reboot without a clean shutdown. Make this less likely to occur
by forcing the data to be written to the storage device before renaming
the file.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2015-08-27 18:06:05 +03:00
Jingxiang Ge
3008d0a6b8 Do not mark BSS entry in use if SSID has changed
This allows a BSS entry to be expired if the AP has changed its SSID
while maintaining the same BSSID and we are associated with the BSS.
Previously, the same BSSID was enough to mark all BSS entries from the
BSSID as in use regardless of the SSID and as such, they could remain in
the wpa_supplicant BSS table indefinitely as long as the association
remaining.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-26 16:46:28 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
137b293963 Remove unnecessary NULL check from LOG_LEVEL handler
cmd cannot be NULL here, so there is no need to check it before calling
os_strlen().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-22 00:22:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
941cd3ec70 P2P: Request fresh scan results after GO Negotiation
The P2P group is not yet operating when going through GO Negotiation
exchange. Previously, an old cached scan result could be used to skip
the scan immediately after the GO Negotiation. While this is quite
unlikely to happen in practice, we can easily force a scan here now with
the generic scan_min_time mechanism. Do that to avoid any corner cases
that a previous instance of the group could have if found in cached scan
results.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-22 00:22:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dfaf11d648 P2P: Require fresh scan results for persistent group re-invocation
The P2P group is not yet operating when going through invitation
exchange for re-invocation. Previously, an old cached scan result could
be used to skip the scan immediately after the invitation exchange.
While this may result in the fastest possible connection, it does have
some issues with cases where the GO takes some time to start up. It
would also be at least theoretically possible for some of the BSS
parameters to be different, so having a fresh scan result from the new
GO instance may be desired in any case.

Add a mechanism to skip scan results that have been last updated before
a specific point in time and as the first user for this mechanism,
require chan results to be more recent than the invitation message
exchange for the P2P Client role in persistent group re-invocation case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-22 00:22:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8493fe3457 eapol_test: Add an example controller script for RADIUS testing
This new script can be used as an example of load testing for RADIUS
authentication servers. It can control multiple eapol_test processes
over the control interface to run EAP-TLS authentication. As an example,
the following commands would run eight instances of eapol_test
concurrently:

for i in 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7; do
    ./eapol_test -T /tmp/eapol_test -i $i > eapol_test.log$i &
done

time ./eapol_test.py --ctrl /tmp/eapol_test --num 8 --iter 100
0: PASS 100
1: PASS 100
2: PASS 100
3: PASS 100
4: PASS 100
5: PASS 100
6: PASS 100
7: PASS 100

real	0m0.339s

time ./eapol_test.py --ctrl /tmp/eapol_test --num 8 --iter 100 --no-fast-reauth
0: PASS 100
1: PASS 100
2: PASS 100
3: PASS 100
4: PASS 100
5: PASS 100
6: PASS 100
7: PASS 100

real	0m1.876s

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-22 00:22:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
048d084d45 eapol_test: Add a new operation mode for control interface use
The -T<ctrl_iface> command line argument can now be used to start
eapol_test in mode where the configuration file is not needed and the
authentication operations are started through the control interface.
Network profile is also managed through the control interface in this
case. This can be used to provide more control for scripted RADIUS
authentication server testing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-21 00:48:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3b3677b3bc eapol_test: Allow interface name to be specified
The new -i<ifname> command line argument can be used to specify the name
of the interface to use. This is mainly to allow unique control
interface names to be defined without having to use multiple
directories.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-20 23:13:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
812f28b79c BoringSSL: Allow internal AES key wrap to be used with "OpenSSL" build
It looks like BoringSSL has removed the AES_wrap_key(), AES_unwrap_key()
API. This broke wpa_supplicant/hostapd build since those functions from
OpenSSL were used to replace the internal AES key wrap implementation.
Add a new build configuration option
(CONFIG_OPENSSL_INTERNAL_AES_WRAP=y) to allow the internal
implementation to be used with CONFIG_OPENSSL=y build to allow build
against the latest BoringSSL version.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-18 01:56:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
35d403096e Set NORMAL_SCAN_REQ on SELECT_NETWORK/ENABLE_NETWORK
wpa_s->scan_req needs to be set in these cases to get correct scanning
behavior. This is mainly needed for starting of AP mode operation
immediately in ap_scan=2 case.

This fixes an issue that was found with mac80211_hwsim test cases in the
following sequence: dbus_autoscan dbus_ap_scan_2_ap_mode_scan

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-17 00:18:32 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
d494ca0be4 P2PS: Consider WPS P2PS method when joining a group
If P2PS PD concludes to use default P2PS method wpas_p2p_scan_res_join()
ignores this value and tries to perform a redundant legacy PD.
Fix this by considering WPS_P2PS method too.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-14 23:56:12 +03:00
Mike Gilbert
cda3a40fce systemd: Order wpa_supplicant before network.target
Ordering the units before network.target causes them to be stopped
after network.target on shutdown. This ensures that any network
filesystems will be unmounted before wpa_supplicant is killed.

Adding Wants=network.target ensures that network.target will be included
in the active dependency graph. This is typical of units which are
involved in networking setup functions.

Signed-off-by: Mike Gilbert <floppym@gentoo.org>
2015-08-14 23:16:14 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2e95cfc188 Add debug prints for wpa_supplicant ctrl_iface socket send operations
This makes it easier to track the output queue state on a control
interface socket and determine what could be causing issues with running
out of space in the buffer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-14 21:18:43 +03:00
Mahesh A Saptasagar
0d0f7ecbb1 Do not stop ongoing PNO sched_scan on association/disconnection
PNO was stopped by the wpa_supplicant during the connection attempts or
while handling disassociation indication. External entities, mainly, the
Android Wi-Fi framework, does not expects PNO to be stopped by other
modules. Hence, do not stop the sched_scan in these scenarios if it is
triggered externally for PNO.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-13 21:10:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0a34b62be9 Do not allow ap_scan=2 scan processing to stop AP mode operation
wpa_supplicant_assoc_try() would result in the currently operating AP to
get stopped if wpa_supplicant_scan() ends up getting triggered without
MANUAL_SCAN_REQ while operating an AP. With ap_scan=2, this could
resulted in unintentional stopping of AP mode operations, so check
explicitly for that case and skip the wpa_supplicant_assoc_try() call if
needed to avoid this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-11 21:46:38 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1fbff0b5c4 D-Bus: Set last_scan_req to MANUAL_SCAN_REQ on Scan() trigger paths
The D-Bus Scan() handler was setting wpa_s->scan_req = MANUAL_SCAN_REQ
on the code path that used wpa_supplicant_req_scan(). However, it did
not do anything similar for the cases where
wpa_supplicant_trigger_scan() is called directly. This could result in
unexpected wpa_s->last_scan_req value and incorrect behavior especially
when using ap_scan=2 and running a scan while operating in AP mode. Fix
this by explicitly setting wpa_s->last_scan_req = MANUAL_SCAN_REQ when
using wpa_supplicant_trigger_scan() from the Scan() handler.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-11 21:44:31 +03:00
Ahmad Kholaif
fbcddaed9a P2P: Support driver preferred freq list for invitation case
When using P2P invitation to re-invoke a persistent P2P group without
specifying the operating channel, query the driver for the preferred
frequency list, and use it to select the operating channel of the group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-11 19:04:45 +03:00
Hu Wang
6108536d7d Drop connection attempt if network is disabled before radio work starts
With the radio work design, it is possible for a network entry to get
disabled (e.g., DISABLE_NETWORK <id>) during the time the connect or
sme-connect radio work waits to start. Previously, only the validity of
the BSS entry and BSSID/SSID was verified when starting the actual
connection step. Add call to wpas_network_disabled() to those checks to
catch the case where the network profile is disabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-10 22:16:19 +03:00
Ahmad Kholaif
8e84921efe P2P: Support driver preferred freq list for Autonomous GO case
When starting an autonomous GO without specifying the operating channel,
query the driver for the preferred frequency list, and use it to select
the operating channel of the GO (if supported).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-10 21:27:42 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
b9da88d6c1 P2PS: Authorize any peer for P2PS method if interface address not known
When P2PS PD with default P2PS method is done, the peer that becomes GO
should authorize the client. However, P2PS specification doesn't require
the client to include its intended interface address in PD
Request/Response. As a result, the P2P Client's interface address may not
be known and any address may need to be authorized.

Previously, client's P2P Device Address was used for authorization,
which is not correct when a dedicated interface is used for P2P Client.
This is not resulting in a connection failure, however it causes a
significant delay (until WPS_PIN_TIME_IGNORE_SEL_REG elapses). Fix this
by authorizing the intended interface address, if known; or any address,
if not known.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-08-06 20:45:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2a098e3668 P2PS: Clean up intended interface address passing to p2ps_prov_complete
Use NULL to indicate if the address is not available instead of fixed
00:00:00:00:00:00. wpas_p2ps_prov_complete() already had code for
converting NULL to that all zeros address for event messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-06 20:45:15 +03:00
Max Stepanov
93f22b4583 P2PS: Fix PD PIN event notifications
Change P2PS P2P-PROV-SHOW-PIN/P2P-PROV-ENTER-PIN event notifications
on PD Request/Response handling to meet required P2PS behavior.

The new implemented scheme:
1. For a legacy P2P provision discovery the event behavior remains
   without changes
2. P2PS PD, advertiser method: DISPLAY, autoaccept: TRUE:
   Advertiser: SHOW-PIN on PD request replied with a status SUCCESS
   Seeker: ENTER-PIN on PD response received with a status SUCCESS
3. P2PS PD, advertiser method: DISPLAY, autoaccept: FALSE:
   Advertiser: SHOW-PIN on PD request replied with a status
     INFO_CURRENTLY_UNAVAILABLE
   Seeker: ENTER-PIN on Follow-on PD request with a status
     SUCCESS_DEFERRED
4. P2PS PD, advertiser method: KEYPAD, autoaccept: TRUE/FALSE:
   Advertiser: ENTER-PIN on PD request replied with a status
     INFO_CURRENTLY_UNAVAILABLE
   Seeker: SHOW-PIN on PD response received with a status
     INFO_CURRENTLY_UNAVAILABLE

This change in behavior breaks the existing test cases
p2ps_connect_keypad_method_nonautoaccept and
p2ps_connect_display_method_nonautoaccept. Those will be fixed in a
followup commit.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-06 13:56:01 +03:00
Ilan Peer
85e152b646 P2P: Fix P2P_FLUSH clearing of p2p_go_avoid_freq
P2P_FLUSH command did not cleanly clear the p2p_go_avoid_freq data
structure, and left it in an inconsistent state, where the range field
was NULL but the num field was not 0. This would have resulted in an
invalid memory access in freq_range_list_includes().

Fix this.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 18:59:59 +03:00
Ilan Peer
3a8f008a24 P2P: Do not perform P2P GO CS in some cases
A P2P GO channel switch should not be triggered in all cases that
require channel list update. Specifically, a P2P GO CS should not
be triggered in case that the P2P GO state changed or in case that
that the P2P GO has just completed a CS.

To fix this, add reason code to wpas_p2p_channel_list_update() and
trigger CS flow only for the relevant cases.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 18:34:47 +03:00
Ilan Peer
dae4c82c95 P2P: Disallow GO CS immediately after GO Negotiation or invitation
A newly created GO might move to another channel before the client was
able to connect to it. This creates a situation where the client
searches the GO on the channel agreed upon during GO Negotiation or
invitation signaling, while the GO is on another channel. This in turn
might lead to delayed connection or connection failure and group
removal.

Fix this by disallowing a GO CS as long as there is some activity that
should delay the switch. If a GO move is not allowed, set a timeout to
re-attempt the move.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 16:14:30 +03:00
Ilan Peer
c2675c87c3 P2P: Consider channel optimizations for additional cases
Re-factor the code, so channel optimizations would be also triggered
upon the following changes: channel updates from the kernel,
disallow_freq interface, etc.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 16:09:21 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
0f4bccdbbe Refactor channel list update event in wpa_supplicant
Update hardware features for all interfaces inside the loop, don't treat
the calling wpa_s instance specially. Perform the P2P channel list
updates after the hardware features are updated. This will prevent P2P
from relying on stale information.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-08-04 16:04:52 +03:00
Ilan Peer
b130812100 P2P: Modify wpas_p2p_init_go_params()
Not all paths in wpas_p2p_init_go_params() verified that the candidate
frequency can be used for GO purposes. Fix this, and in addition
re-factor the code to put better emphasis on the frequency selection
priorities.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 00:38:54 +03:00
Ilan Peer
a7160f7ede P2P: Remove GO handling in avoid frequency event
Remove the code that considers removing GOs from their current
channel due to frequency interference, as this is already handled
as part of the P2P channels update.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 00:32:36 +03:00
Ilan Peer
e280110d17 P2P: Move a GO to a frequency that is also supported by the client
A P2P GO interface that was instantiated after a GO Negotiation or
Invitation holds the intersection of frequencies between the GO and the
client. In case the GO is going to move to another frequency, allow it
to move only to a frequency that is also supported by the client.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 00:27:13 +03:00
Ilan Peer
5e1f480500 P2P: Add a function to compute the group common freqs
Add a function to compute the group common frequencies, and
use it to update the group_common_frequencies as part of the
channel switch flows.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 00:18:51 +03:00
Ilan Peer
1a471ff081 P2P: Move a GO from its operating frequency
Upon any change in the currently used channels evaluate if a GO should
move to a different operating frequency, where the possible scenarios:

1. The frequency that the GO is currently using is no longer valid,
   due to regulatory reasons, and thus the GO must be moved to some
   other frequency.
2. Due to Multi Concurrent Channel (MCC) policy considerations, it would
   be preferable, based on configuration settings, to prefer Same
   Channel Mode (SCM) over concurrent operation in multiple channels.
   The supported policies:

   - prefer SCM: prefer moving the GO to a frequency used by some other
     interface.
   - prefer SCM if Peer supports: prefer moving the GO to a frequency
     used by some other station interface iff the other station
     interface is using a frequency that is common between the local and
     the peer device (based on the GO Negotiation/Invitation signaling).
   - Stay on the current frequency.

Currently, the GO transition to another frequency is handled by a
complete tear down and re-setup of the GO. Still need to add CSA flow to
the considerations.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-08-04 00:14:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ab62f96f55 Move debug level string conversion functions to wpa_debug.c
This makes it possible to use these helper functions from hostapd as
well as the current use in wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-03 17:44:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
84bcb4e7a9 FST: Mark fst_ies buffer const
This buffer is owned by the FST module, so mark it const in the
set_ies() callback to make it clearer which component is responsible for
modifying and freeing this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-08-03 17:40:30 +03:00
Daichi Ueura
2665c26f91 Android: Handle STATUS-NO_EVENTS command in wpa_cli
NO_EVENTS parameter was added to STATUS command by commit
a6ab82d7b4 ('Android: Add NO_EVENTS
parameter to status command'). This patch adds handling of the new
parameter in wpa_cli so that "status no_events" can be used to specify
this parameter.

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2015-08-02 21:37:10 +03:00
Daichi Ueura
884c649e26 Android: Make wpa_cli work on wifi.interface without extra params
Currently wpa_cli connects to global control interface if -i/-p
parameters are not specified. wpa_cli on global control interface
is not useful since the prefix like "IFNAME=wlan0 " needs to be
added to some commands like "IFNAME=wlan0 scan". And, specifying
-i/-p parameters every time is annoying. To improve efficiency of
debugging, this patch enables to make wpa_cli work without extra
parameters.

If you still want to connect to global control interface,
the following command can be used instead:

 $ wpa_cli -g@android:wpa_wlan0 (or -gwlan0)

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2015-08-02 21:37:10 +03:00
Masashi Honma
ecd40fef74 mesh: Fix mesh SAE auth on low spec devices
The mesh SAE auth often fails with master branch. By bisect I found
commit eb5fee0bf5 ('SAE: Add side-channel
protection to PWE derivation with ECC') causes this issue. This does not
mean the commit has a bug. This is just a CPU resource issue.

After the commit, sae_derive_pwe_ecc() spends 101(msec) on my PC (Intel
Atom N270 1.6GHz). But dot11RSNASAERetransPeriod is 40(msec). So
auth_sae_retransmit_timer() is always called and it can causes
continuous frame exchanges. Before the commit, it was 23(msec).

On the IEEE 802.11 spec, the default value of dot11RSNASAERetransPeriod
is defined as 40(msec). But it looks short because generally mesh
functionality will be used on low spec devices. Indeed Raspberry Pi B+
(ARM ARM1176JZF-S 700MHz) requires 287(msec) for new
sae_derive_pwe_ecc().

So this patch makes the default to 1000(msec) and makes it configurable.

This issue does not occur on infrastructure SAE because the
dot11RSNASAERetransPeriod is not used on it.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-08-02 21:37:10 +03:00
Michael Olbrich
be11a59486 P2P: Cancel group formation when deleting a group during group formation
Otherwise P2P remains in provisioning state and continues to skip
extended listening forever.

Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de>
2015-08-02 21:37:09 +03:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
86e2dcf5a6 P2P: Fix update of listen_reg_class and listen_channel
Allow proper update for listen_reg_class and listen_channel with
changed_parameters [CFG_CHANGED_P2P_LISTEN_CHANNEL] configuration for
command received through ctrl_interface. Without this, "set
p2p_listen_channel" and "set p2p_listen_reg_class" do not update the
listen channel. The D-Bus version was already setting these flags.

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
2015-08-02 21:37:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9f59fe8dc8 P2P: Do not clear wpa_s->go_dev_addr before group removal
This variable is needed to figure out whether a wpa_supplicant interface
is for a P2P group that is (or was) connected to a specific GO. The
previous implementation was able to find such a case only when there was
an association with the GO. However, this may be needed even if there is
a temporary disconnection from the GO. Keep the GO device address
information over such temporary disconnections and only remove it on
group termination. This fixes an issue with D-Bus Peer PropertiesChanged
signals for the Groups property in case a P2P group gets removed due to
group idle timeout instead of explicit group termination command (local
request) or GO notification.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-02 21:37:09 +03:00
Gautam
d4e597959c P2P: Fix P2P configuration file name
The P2P configuration file is wrongly set as STA configuration file,
even though a separate configuration file is mentioned with '-m' option.
Add initialization and deallocation of global.params->conf_p2p_dev to
fix this.

Signed-off-by: Gautam <gautams@broadcom.com>
2015-08-02 21:37:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7cb53ded11 Add build option to remove all internal RC4 uses
The new CONFIG_NO_RC4=y build option can be used to remove all internal
hostapd and wpa_supplicant uses of RC4. It should be noted that external
uses (e.g., within a TLS library) do not get disabled when doing this.

This removes capability of supporting WPA/TKIP, dynamic WEP keys with
IEEE 802.1X, WEP shared key authentication, and MSCHAPv2 password
changes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-02 16:52:56 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1e4f7bf5d0 Add 'GET_CAPABILITY fips' to enable runtime check for CONFIG_FIPS=y
This can be used to check whether the running wpa_supplicant version was
built with CONFIG_FIPS=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-02 16:52:56 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
835c89a16b EAP-TTLS: Disable CHAP, MSCHAP, and MSCHAPV2 in CONFIG_FIPS=y builds
FIPS builds do not include support for MD4/MD5, so disable
EAP-TTLS/CHAP, MSCHAP, and MSCHAPV2 when CONFIG_FIPS=y is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-01 21:07:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
276a3c44dd OpenSSL: Implement aes_wrap/aes_unwrap through EVP for CONFIG_FIPS=y
The OpenSSL internal AES_wrap_key() and AES_unwrap_key() functions are
unfortunately not available in FIPS mode. Trying to use them results in
"aes_misc.c(83): OpenSSL internal error, assertion failed: Low level API
call to cipher AES forbidden in FIPS mode!" and process termination.
Work around this by reverting commit
f19c907822 ('OpenSSL: Implement aes_wrap()
and aes_unwrap()') changes for CONFIG_FIPS=y case. In practice, this
ends up using the internal AES key wrap/unwrap implementation through
the OpenSSL EVP API which is available in FIPS mode. When CONFIG_FIPS=y
is not used, the OpenSSL AES_wrap_key()/AES_unwrap_key() API continues
to be used to minimize code size.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-08-01 16:56:59 +03:00
Ahmad Kholaif
fc71f7d99d P2P: Expose driver preferred frequency list fetch to P2P
This adds a callback function that can be used from the P2P module to
request the current preferred list of operating channels from the
driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-30 22:13:48 +03:00
Ahmad Kholaif
370017d968 P2P: Use preferred frequency list from the local driver
If the driver supports the preferred frequency list extension, use this
information from the driver when no explicitly configured preference
list (p2p_pref_chan) is present for P2P operating channel selection.
This commit adds this for GO Negotiation and Invitation use cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-30 22:13:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
34c5267bbc Return error from wpa_drv_get_pref_freq_list() if no driver support
Commit 983422088f ('nl80211: Add means to
query preferred channels') return success if no driver wrapper callback
was provided for fetching the preferred channel list. That is
problematic since the *num argument is not updated and uninitialized
freq_list could end up getting used with arbitrary frequency values. Fix
this by returning error in case the values were not available due to
driver wrapper not implementing the function. This matches the style
used in the driver_nl80211.c implementation for the case where the
driver does not support such fetch operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-30 22:13:47 +03:00
Ahmad Kholaif
983422088f nl80211: Add means to query preferred channels
Extend the QCA vendor specific nl80211 interface to query the preferred
frequency list from driver and add a new wpa_cli command to query this
information.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-29 19:46:31 +03:00
Ahmad Kholaif
7c813acf9c P2P: Inform driver of the operating channel following group formation
Upon GO Negotiation completion, if the remote peer becomes GO, send a
hint event over QCA vendor specific interface to inform the driver of
the likely operating channel of the P2P GO.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-29 19:10:16 +03:00
Srinivas Dasari
844dfeb804 QCA vendor command support to set band to driver
Add vendor command to pass SET setband command to the driver and read
the updated channel list from driver when this notification succeeds.
This allows the driver to update its internal channel lists based on
setband configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-28 21:00:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
16bc3b8935 OpenSSL: Add SHA256 support in openssl_tls_prf() for TLSv1.2
This is needed when enabling TLSv1.2 support for EAP-FAST since the
SSL_export_keying_material() call does not support the needed parameters
for TLS PRF and the external-to-OpenSSL PRF needs to be used instead.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-28 21:00:17 +03:00
Max Stepanov
88f3d7c980 P2PS: Add feature capability to PD events
Report the feature capability on P2PS-PROV-START and P2PS-PROV-DONE
ctrl-iface events. A feature capability value is specified as
'feature_cap=<hex>' event parameter, where <val> is a hexadecimal
string of feature capability bytes in a PD Response frame.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-27 00:47:19 +03:00
Max Stepanov
0670de74ae P2PS: Add CPT parameter to P2PS_PROVISION and P2PS_PROVISION_RESP
Add a parameter allowing to specify a value of Coordination
Protocol Transport to P2PS_PROVISION and P2PS_PROVISION_RESP commands.

Extend the p2ps_provision structure to contain cpt_priority and
cpt_mask properties and initialize them on a P2PS PD request command.

The format of the parameter:
    cpt=<cpt>[:cpt]

where <cpt> is CPT name e.g. UDP or MAC. The CPT names are listed
according to their preferences to be used for a specific P2PS session.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-27 00:47:19 +03:00
Max Stepanov
e2b7fbf2fb P2PS: Add CPT parameter to P2P_SERVICE_ADD asp command
Add Coordination Transport Protocol parameter to P2P_SERVICE_ADD
asp command.

Extend p2ps_advertisement structure to contain CPT priorities
and a supported CPT bitmask.

The format of the new parameter:
    cpt=<cpt>[:<cpt>]

where <cpt> is a name of the Coordination Protocol Transport.
This implementation supports two CPT names: UDP and MAC.
The order of specified CPTs defines their priorities where
the first one has the highest priority.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-27 00:47:19 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5dbd3bf915 FST: Avoid memory leak on double FST-ATTACH
Do not allow wpa_s->fst to be replaced when processing FST-ATTACH
command for an interface that has already been attached.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-26 18:12:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b525cbab86 wpa_cli: Skip action script execution when eloop termination is pending
Try to exit more quickly by avoiding execution of the action script for
any pending events if the process is requested to be killed. This may
help in avoiding hitting the two second SIGALRM workaround in eloop in
case some of the action scripts block for long period of time.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-22 17:10:32 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
df4cea898c FST: Include fst/fst.h explicitly into wpa_supplicant/ctrl_iface.c
This header file is needed to get struct fst_iface_cfg and struct
fst_wpa_obj defined. While it does currently get pulled in through
ap/hostapd.h and ap/ap_config.h, a more explicit inclusion may be a
cleaner option for future.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-21 13:15:24 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3188aabaf1 Add shared periodic cleanup function for AP mode
This new mechanism can be used to combine multiple periodic AP
(including P2P GO) task into a single eloop timeout to minimize number
of wakeups for the process. hostapd gets its own periodic caller and
wpa_supplicant uses the previously added timer to trigger these calls.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-20 13:33:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8c0d0ff22e Use a single cleanup timer per wpa_supplicant process
Previously, one timeout per process (by default every 30 seconds) was
used P2P peer expiration and another per-interface timeout (every 10
seconds) was used to expire BSS entries. Merge these to a single
per-process timeout that triggers every 10 seconds to minimize number of
process wakeups due to periodic operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-20 13:28:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a0f04da517 FST: Mark get_mb_ie() return value const
The caller is not expected to free or modify the value since this is
returning a reference to a buffer maintained by the upper layer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-18 17:23:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b7a07937ee FST: Show FST IE update details in debug log
This makes it more convenient to debug FST IE updates.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-17 16:29:20 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
daae49955f Add global wpa_supplicant DUP_NETWORK command
This command allows network variables to be copied from one network to
another when the networks belong to different radios. This is similar to
the per-interface DUP_NETWORK command. On the global control interface,
the command syntax is as follows:

DUP_NETWORK <src ifname> <dst ifname> <src network id> <dst network id> <variable name>

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:16 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
a8dab08a28 FST: Testing support
This patch introduces infrastructure needed for FST module tests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:16 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
79c7b36d12 FST: wpa_supplicant build rules
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:15 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
3794af2dc1 FST: wpa_supplicant control interface
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:15 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
9fbfd1b0d4 FST: Send FST Action frame for processing (wpa_supplicant)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:15 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
b36a3a65aa FST: Integration into wpa_supplicant
This commit integrates the FST into the wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:15 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
55de4d4ba3 FST: wpa_supplicant [FST] flag for BSS in scan results
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:15 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
76ca15b7db FST: wpa_supplicant configuration parameters
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 18:26:15 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
ee1e3f57b5 hostapd: Global control interface notifications
This commit implements hostapd global control interface notifications
infrastructure. hostapd global control interface clients issue
ATTACH/DETACH commands to register and deregister with hostapd
correspondingly - the same way as for any other hostapd/wpa_supplicant
control interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-07-16 12:33:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5650d379a3 OpenSSL: Add option to disable use of TLSv1.0
The new phase1 config parameter value tls_disable_tlsv1_0=1 can now be
used to disable use of TLSv1.0 for a network configuration. This can be
used to force a newer TLS version to be used. For example,
phase1="tls_disable_tlsv1_0=1 tls_disable_tlsv1_1=1" would indicate that
only TLS v1.2 is accepted.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-08 19:27:57 +03:00
Hahn, Maital
aa517ae227 wpa_supplicant: Fix a typo in wpa_scan_result_compar()
A typo in wpa_scan_result_compar() caused wrong scan results sorting
(and wrong roaming decision). This fixes a copy-paste regression
introduced by commit a1b790eb9d ('Select
AP based on estimated maximum throughput').

Signed-off-by: Maital Hahn <maitalm@ti.com>
2015-07-08 16:52:42 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
5cc6ec0f68 P2PS: Set intended interface address correctly for new group
If a device may be an explicit GO, it adds the GO details in the PD
Request. First, we try to reuse an active GO. If it is not present, we
try to reuse a non-active persistent group. In the latter case, if a
dedicated P2P interface is needed, the intended address should be that
of the pending interface. However, the wpas_get_go_info() provided the
ssid->bssid address, which is the address of the P2P device. This might
result in an incorrect intended interface attribute in the PD Request in
case a separate group interface is used.

Fix this by setting group_iface variable to true only if a dedicated
interface should be used and set the attribute accordingly.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-07 20:57:07 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
1f14e2bf92 P2PS: Add PD Response validation
Validate the PD Response frame contents more thoroughly when it is used
for P2PS.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-07 20:52:38 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
1f1a08b4cc P2PS: Add intended iface address during PD for persistent group
When persistent group is used and the peer is GO in this group,
intended interface attribute should be added to PD request/response.
Not doing so violates the spec.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-07 20:41:19 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
23bb9828a3 P2PS: Fix P2PS-PROV-DONE event on GO
If after P2PS PD the device should become a GO it sends P2PS-PROV-DONE
event which contains the GO interface name. If the GO isn't running yet
the device may use pending interface name. However, when the GO is
started, pending interface name will be removed.

Fix the GO interface name in P2PS-PROV-DONE event by copying the
interface name instead of saving the pointer.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-07 20:34:14 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
a698d6c85f P2PS: Use wpas_p2p_create_iface() to check if dedicated iface is needed
Call wpas_p2p_create_iface() instead of just checking p2p_no_group_iface
config value. Not doing so, resulted in an incorrect behavior when the
driver sets WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_DEDICATED_P2P_DEVICE flag.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-07-07 20:30:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
66f1e078e7 DATA_TEST_TX: Avoid ubsan warning on 0x80<<24 not fitting in int
Use unsigned constant instead of signed to avoid warning with the LSB
being set in an int.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-07 16:25:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
75352270fa Avoid misaligned IPv4 header accesses in DATA_TEST_* commands
The IPv4 header after the Ethernet header is not 32-bit aligned and the
previous version ended up accessing 32-bit members at misaligned
addresses.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-07 16:25:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
96e8c13da7 D-Bus: Fix dont_quote const declaration
Commit 38279bdb35 ('D-Bus: Coding style
cleanup') handled the dbus_new_handlers.c change properly, but misplaced
the second 'const' in dbus_old_handlers.c in a way that resulted in
duplicated const rather than marking the actual value const.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-07-07 16:25:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2da525651d Add backtrace-based error path testing mechanism
The new TEST_FAIL and GET_FAIL control interface commands can be used
similarly to the earlier TEST_ALLOC_FAIL/GET_ALLOC_FAIL design. The new
version is more generic framework allowing any function to be annotated
for failure testing with the TEST_FAIL() macro. This mechanism is only
available in builds with CONFIG_WPA_TRACE_BFD=y and
CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y. For other builds, the TEST_FAIL() macro is
defined to return 0 to allow the compiler to remove the test code from
normal production builds.

As the first test site, allow os_get_random() to be marked for failing
based on call backtrace.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-29 23:23:56 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
55413ce072 P2P: Do not allow 40 MHz co-ex PRI/SEC switch to force MCC
Do not allow 40 MHz co-ex PRI/SEC switch to force us to change our PRI
channel if we have an existing connection on the selected PRI channel
since doing multi-channel concurrency is likely to cause more harm than
using different PRI/SEC selection in environment with multiple BSSes on
these two channels with mixed 20 MHz or PRI channel selection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-28 18:14:58 +03:00
Stepanov, Max
a9ea609ce8 P2PS: Fix p2p_find last parameter handling
In p2p_find command line processing a loop searching for multiple
'seek=' parameters modifies cmd buffer adding '\0' terminators.
The 'freq=' parameter is handled after that and can be
lost if a 'freq=' follows 'seek=' in a command line.
Fix it by moving a handling of 'freq=' parameter to be processed
before 'seek=' handling loop.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-06-27 23:49:15 +03:00
Dmitry Shmidt
4f39908b60 Send CTRL-EVENT-NETWORK-NOT-FOUND if no suitable network was found
This provides more information to upper layer programs on what happens
with connection attempts in cases where the enabled networks are not
found in scan results.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2015-06-27 11:08:08 +03:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
123df27eae D-Bus: Fix typos in debug print
Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
2015-06-26 23:01:37 +03:00
Kevin Cernekee
a1407217b1 Android: Rename ANDROID_P2P_STUB to ANDROID_LIB_STUB
If BOARD_HOSTAPD_PRIVATE_LIB is not used on an Android build, we will
need to replace both the p2p functions *and* wpa_driver_nl80211_driver_cmd
in order to successfully link.  Let's make the name more generic so it is
more obvious what it is used for.

Suggested-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Kevin Cernekee <cernekee@google.com>
2015-06-26 22:46:16 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
2ba4de37cb D-Bus: Add documentation for wpas_dbus_signal_peer_groups_changed()
This is needed to add this function into Doxygen documentation.

Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-26 22:44:41 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
e48b5e24a7 D-Bus: Fix typo in dbus signal function documentation
Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-26 22:44:41 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
09d5048b76 D-Bus: Add function documentation for wpas_dbus_unregister_interface()
This is needed to add this function into Doxygen documentation.

Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-26 22:44:41 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
adfbbd2b48 D-Bus: Add function documentation for wpas_dbus_register_interface()
This is needed to add this function into Doxygen documentation.

Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-26 22:44:41 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
c5967f027a D-Bus: Fix wpas_dbus_signal_p2p_invitation_result() documentation
Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-26 22:44:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6a58444d27 SAE: Verify that own/peer commit-scalar and COMMIT-ELEMENT are different
This check explicitly for reflection attack and stops authentication
immediately if that is detected instead of continuing to the following
4-way handshake that would fail due to the attacker not knowing the key
from the SAE exchange.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-23 23:10:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8e2a3a4c21 dbus: Do not initialize variable twice
There is no point in initializing 'success' to FALSE when the actual
value is set just below this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-23 21:16:35 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c1a14ef42f Do not check unsigned size is less than zero
The variables here are unsigned and as such, cannot have a negative
value. Use == 0 instead of <= 0 to make this cleaner.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-23 21:16:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f6332b0be1 wpa_gui: Initialize WpaGuiApp::w in the constructor
This gets rid of a static analyzer warning. The actual value for
WpaGuiApp::w will be set after the constructor has returned, so this
value was not really used uninitialized.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-23 20:23:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
91b7a5e146 Use unsigned/signed printf format more consistently
These configuration parameters did not use matching printf format string
parameters (signed vs. unsigned). While these configuratin values are,
in practice, small unsigned integers, the implementation should use
matching types to write these.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-23 20:08:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
04e6c4cc50 Fix SAE group selection in an error case
The sae_groups parameter is zero terminated array, not -1 terminated, so
must check the value against <= 0 to break out from the loop.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-20 23:29:57 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ce8963fc9f Remove WEP40/WEP104 cipher suite support for WPA/WPA2
As far as IEEE 802.11 standard is concerned, WEP is deprecated, but at
least in theory, allowed as a group cipher. This option is unlikely to
be deployed anywhere and to clean up the implementation, we might as
well remove all support for this combination.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-20 23:04:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ee140ef98f FT: Stop association attempt if Auth response processing fails (SME)
Call the FT processing function directly instead of going through
wpa_supplicant_event() to process FT Authentication frame in SME case.
This allows parsing error to be used to trigger immediate failure for
the connection instead of trying to proceed to reassociation step that
cannot succeed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-20 17:36:58 +03:00
Ilan Peer
f43c1ae798 P2P: Handle P2P Device dedicated interface parent removal
In case of a network interface removal, check if the interface
was also the parent interface of the P2P Device dedicated interface.
If this is the case, then stop the P2P Device functionality, and
remove the P2P Device dedicated interface.

In case that the interface is added again and P2P Device
functionality can be enabled again, add a new P2P Device dedicated
interface and allow further P2P Device functionality.

In case that the P2P Device dedicated interface is re-created, the
original P2P Device configuration file is needed, so store it in
the global params (instead in the wpa_interface configuration).

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-19 16:22:26 +03:00
Eliad Peller
38dcc86cb7 P2P: Consider ht/vht on P2P_GROUP_ADD command (with no params)
p2p_ctrl_group_add() takes care of various configuration options (such
as ht/vht) before calling wpas_p2p_group_add(), so use it (just like
when P2P_GROUP_ADD is called with additional params).

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-06-19 15:57:16 +03:00
Eliad Peller
29292d53ee ctrl_iface: Make p2p_ctrl_group_add() more robust
Parse each parameter individually and combine all the function calls.
This will allow further patch to call it with no parameters (currently
this might result in failure).

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-06-19 15:56:54 +03:00
Eliad Peller
e4a80d89bd P2P: Fix secondary channel selection for HT40
wpas_p2p_get_ht40_mode() used blacklist approach (bw != BW20) to find
the relevant op_class, but didn't take into account other non-BW40
cases, like BW80, that had been added to the bw enum after the initial
implementation. Fix this by looking for the specific BW40 bw cases.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-06-19 15:50:40 +03:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
4e7175827e dbus: Add RemoveClient method to remove a client from local GO
This is equivalent to the P2P_REMOVE_CLIENT command on control
interface. This can be used to remove the specified client [as object
path or string format interface address] from all groups (operating and
persistent) from the local GO.

Argument(s): peer[object path] OR iface[string format MAC address]

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Jijo Jacob <jijo.jacob@samsung.com>
2015-06-19 12:55:54 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
f0a79c9403 D-Bus: Fix wpas_dbus_register_peer() documentation
Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-19 12:40:29 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
95d62a6c20 D-Bus: Add missing params in WPS function documentation
This adds missing parameters in all WPS events related function
documentation.

Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-19 12:38:11 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
790429b520 D-Bus: Fix function documentation for wpas_dbus_signal_p2p_go_neg_resp()
Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-19 12:35:40 +03:00
Maneesh Jain
92fe746e19 D-Bus: Add function documentation for wpas_dbus_signal_p2p_go_neg_req()
This is needed to add this function into Doxygen documentation.

Signed-off-by: Maneesh Jain <maneesh.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-19 12:31:28 +03:00
Avraham Stern
e1dffa3b2c P2P: Fix PBC overlap detection
PBC overlap detection searches for another BSS with active PBC in the
BSS table. However, when a separate P2P interface is used, scan results
without P2P IE are not saved in the BSS table, so non-P2P BSS's with
active PBC will not be detected.

Fix this by iterating only the WPS AP array instead of the BSS table.
This is also more efficient since only WPS APs may have active PBC. This
also fixes hwsim test "grpform_pbc_overlap" when a dedicated P2P Device
is used.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-06-19 11:25:21 +03:00
Ilan Peer
de7b02fd18 P2P: Use the P2P Device interface in wpas_p2p_fallback_to_go_neg()
Previously the wpa_s->parent interface was used, which is not
necessarily the P2P Device management interface.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-19 11:07:50 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
129b621653 P2PS: Fix P2P_FIND seek parameter parsing
Only the first seek=<service name> parameter was accepted from the
P2P_FIND command. Fix this to go through all seek parameters to
construct the list of service hash values to seek.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-18 17:27:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
13f6f617ee wpa_cli: Fix process termination in wpa_cli action mode case
Commit 4be9f27595 ('wpa_cli: Use eloop
during connection attempts in interactive mode') did not take into
account the needs for signal processing in action mode. eloop_run() was
not called in this case and the internal select() loop would block eloop
processing anyway and prevent clean shutdown. Fix this by using eloop
for action mode operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-18 13:50:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
14fd03312c Clear control interface command explicitly from stack
The control interface commands may include passwords or other private
key material, so clear it explicitly from memory as soon as the
temporary buffer is not needed anymore.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-17 16:29:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d95c5994c8 P2P: Fix group interface addition failure properly for concurrent case
It was possible for a P2P group formation failure to result in a
concurrent station mode operation getting disconnected in the specific
error case where group interface addition fails after a successful GO
Negotiation. Fix this by skipping the wpas_p2p_group_delete() call in
this specific case since the group interface does not exists anymore at
the point wpas_group_formation_completed() gets called.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-15 23:43:00 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
0799b3f899 P2P: Specify frequency when sending Probe Response frame
If the RX frequency of the Probe Request frame is known, specify it when
sending the Probe Response frame. This is needed when the Probe Request
frame is received on another virtual interface, for example, when a GO
or P2PS client are discoverable on the group operating channel.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-14 23:16:55 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
5d180a7739 drivers: Add freq parameter to send_mlme() function
Change send_mlme() API to allow sending management frames on a specific
channel, overriding the internal driver decision.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-14 23:16:55 +03:00
Max Stepanov
07c1e987d5 P2PS: Enable Probe Request frame processing by P2P Client
1. Add global p2p_cli_probe property to enable/disable Probe Request
frame RX reporting for connected P2P Clients. The property can be set to
0 - disable or 1 - enable. The default value is 0.

2. Enable Probe Request frame RX reporting for P2P Client on
WPA_COMPLETED state if p2p_cli_probe property is set to 1. Disable it
when an interface state is changing to any other state.

3. Don't cancel Probe Request frame RX reporting on wpa_stop_listen for
a connected P2P Client handling Probe Request frames.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-14 23:16:55 +03:00
Max Stepanov
734ddf6125 P2P: Add rx_freq parameter to Probe Request frame handler
In some cases, Probe Request frames can be received by a peer not only
on a listen channel. In this case an additional rx_freq parameter
explitly contains a Probe Request frame RX frequency. In case rx_freq is
set to 0, a Probe Request frame RX channel is assumed to be our own
listen channel (p2p->cfg->channel).

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-14 23:16:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e6012e839d P2P: Update target GO Device Address from BSS entry during join
It is possible for P2P_CONNECT-join command to be issued on a GO's P2P
Interface Address before the P2P peer entry is available to map this
into the GO's P2P Device Address. This could result in the join
operation failing to continue after receiving PD Response due to the
address mismatch (source address = P2P Device Address while only the P2P
Interface Address is known). Fix this by updating the pending join P2P
Device Address based on the BSS entry, if needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-06-14 23:16:55 +03:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
e11776a528 Combine multiple function calls to a single statement
This cleans up p2p_ctrl_group_add() to share a single call to
wpas_p2p_group_add().

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
2015-06-14 11:42:29 +03:00
MAYANK HAARIT
b649c0afd4 dbus: Add Reconnect command to D-Bus Interface
This has same behavior as the ctrl_iface RECONNECT command.

Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
2015-06-14 11:33:54 +03:00
Amr BEN ABDESSALEM
0c9fb14ec4 P2P: Add Operating class 125 for P2P supported channels
Add operating class 125 (channels 149..169) to the list of P2P supported
channels. This allows the 5 GHz channels 161 and 169 to be used for P2P
GO when those channels are allowed for AP mode in the current regulatory
domain.

Signed-off-by: Amr BEN ABDESSALEM <amrx.ben.abdessalem@intel.com>
2015-06-12 20:39:49 +03:00
Ilan Peer
57e832de37 GAS: Remove all radio works before calling gas_query_deinit()
Remove all gas-query radio works before calling gas_query_deinit()
as gas_query_deinit() flow frees the query context, which might
be later be accessed from the radio work callback (and result
with unexpected behavior, e.g., segmentation fault).

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-06-11 02:57:34 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
661888be39 P2P: Fix persistent group profile on manual disabled=2 change
ssid->p2p_persistent_group was left to its old value when changing a
network profile to/from P2P persistent group type (disabled=2). This
could result in unexpected behavior when using an incomplete persistent
group profile. This was mainly visible through D-Bus network profile
handling where a persistent group would not be unregistered insome
cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-11 00:02:05 +03:00
Avichal Agarwal
1a2f7ca1b8 D-Bus: Add WPS pbc-overlap Event
This sends an Event D-Bus signal with name "pbc-overlap" for
WPS-EVENT-OVERLAP.

Signed-off-by: Avichal Agarwal <avichal.a@samsung.com>
2015-06-10 20:51:30 +03:00
Amit Khatri
4f369652da P2P: Add ModelNumber and SerialNumber info into D-Bus peer interface
Signed-off-by: Amit Khatri <amit.khatri@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Rahul Jain <rahul.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-10 19:11:12 +03:00
Amit Khatri
2899cba622 P2P: Add ModelName info into D-Bus peer interface
Signed-off-by: Amit Khatri <amit.khatri@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Rahul Jain <rahul.jain@samsung.com>
2015-06-10 19:06:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
995a3a06f4 Document the wpa_msg_cb "global" parameter
Instead of an int variable with magic values 0, 1, 2, use an enum that
gives clearer meaning to the values now that the original boolean type
global argument is not really a boolean anymore.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-10 16:02:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e66bcedd3e Do not set own_disconnect_req flag if not connected
This fixes some issues where a disconnection event may get ignored if an
earlier operation to remove or disable a network resulted in an attempt
to disconnect event though no connection was in place.
wpa_s->current_ssid != NULL alone is not sufficient to determine that
there will be a driver event notifying completion of such disconnection
request. Set own_disconnect_req to 1 only if wpa_s->wpa_state is also
indicating that there is a connection or an attempt to complete one.

This showed up in a failure, e.g., when running the hwsim test case
scan_int followed by ap_vlan_wpa2_psk_radius_required where the latter
ended up not processing a connection failure event and getting stuck not
trying to run a new scan and connection attempt.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-10 15:42:57 +03:00
Jason A. Donenfeld
8d2ed87d82 wpa_gui: Port to Qt5
This adds support for Qt5 while still preserving support for building
with Qt4. The same source code builds with both Qt versions now. The
functionality should be identical.

Signed-off-by: Jason A. Donenfeld <Jason@zx2c4.com>
2015-06-10 14:03:48 +03:00
Ondřej Caletka
e1ede80d3b eapol_test: Support IPv6 for authentication server
This allows testing RADIUS servers over IPv6.

Signed-off-by: Ondřej Caletka <ondrej@caletka.cz>
2015-06-10 13:53:22 +03:00
MAYANK HAARIT
aa2b12562b P2P: Add GO Intent of connecting device in GO Negotiation Request event
Add GO Intent information of connecting device in GO Negotiation Request
event which will help applications to decide its own GO intent value in
advance and can avoid failure cases when both devices use GO Intent 15
depending on application requirement.

Signed-off-by: Mayank Haarit <mayank.h@samsung.com>
2015-06-06 18:16:39 +03:00
Krishna Vamsi
a80651d067 Add support to request a scan with specific SSIDs
Support a request to scan specific SSIDs given by user with the SCAN
command. The SSID list can be suffixed to the scan command as follows.
For example, if SSIDs "ABC" and "abc123" need to be specifically
scanned, the command should be "SCAN ssid 414243 ssid 616263313233". The
value of the SSID is passed in hexadecimal representation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-05 15:55:26 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
94687a0aae WPS: Allow the priority for the WPS networks to be configured
This commit adds a configurable parameter (wps_priority) to specify the
priority for the networks derived through WPS connection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-04 13:55:16 +03:00
Anton Nayshtut
09d57ce40e wpa_supplicant: Remove trailing whitespace
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-06-02 20:06:55 +03:00
Amit Khatri
dc1a341dec P2P: Add manufacturer info into D-Bus peer interface
Allow the Manufacturer information for a found P2P peer device to be
fetched through the D-Bus interface similarly to p2p_peer <mac address>
on ctrl interface.

Signed-off-by: Amit Khatri <amit.khatri@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Rahul Jain <rahul.jain@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashutosh Kaushik <k.ashutosh@samsung.com>
2015-05-29 21:28:26 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
333039596e P2P: Add P2P Cancel method over D-Bus interface
This patch adds P2P Cancel method over
fi.w1.wpa_supplicant1.Interface.P2PDevice dbus interface.

Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2015-05-29 21:05:17 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
87d3c62835 WPS: Add WPS Cancel method over D-Bus interface
Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2015-05-29 20:55:08 +03:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
eda9d84dfd P2P: Fix a potential memory leak in a P2P+NFC corner case
Avoid memory leak due to previous allocation for ssid->ssid. It does not
look like this is hit in normal cases, but at might be possible for the
SSID to get set if the peer is present in previous scan results and WPS
code ends up copying the SSID from there.

Signed-off-by: Purushottam Kushwaha <p.kushwaha@samsung.com>
2015-05-29 20:41:25 +03:00
Krishna Vamsi
701d9729b3 Add libwpa_client build option to use a dynamic library
Add support to compile libwpa_client.so. This can be used by external
programs to interact with the wpa_supplicant control interface. Also
rename the static version of this library to libwpa_client.a to be
consistent with the name used previous in Android builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-05-29 15:25:52 +03:00
Krishna Vamsi
ccad05a95c P2P: Restart group formation timer upon receiving new Inv Req
A new Invitation Request might be received on a just started persistent
group if the previous Invitation Response sent isn't received at the
peer (GO of the persistent group). When the peer sends an Invitation
Request again, treat it as start of group formation and restart the
group formation timer at this point of time.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-05-29 13:30:26 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
4d3be9cdd1 Postpone updating of wpa_s->current_bss till association event
In the case of driver-based BSS selection, a bssid_hint in the connect
request might not result in to the selection of the same BSS. Thus,
postpone the updation of the wpa_s->current_bss till the association
event is received unless the BSSID is forced. This fixes issues where
wpa_s->current_bss may end up being updated to point to the BSS that
wpa_supplicant provided as a hint for a roaming case, but then not
restored if the driver decides to "return" to the current BSS instead.
This could result in some operations (e.g., WNM BSS TM response) not
working properly due to incorrect BSS being identified in
wpa_s->current_bss.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-05-29 12:18:13 +03:00
Ilan Peer
b4342ca4d8 P2P: Use p2p_init_wpa_s for P2P command redirection over D-Bus
D-Bus used the p2p_dev member in struct wpa_supplicant to track the
interface used for P2P Device operations. However, this is not needed as
the interface used for P2P Device operations is stored in struct
wpa_global->p2p_init_wpa_s.

Replace all the redirections to wpa_s->p2p_dev with redirections to
wpa_s->global->p2p_init_wpa_s and removed this member as it is no
longer needed.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
96512a00d0 P2P: Fix D-Bus PresenceRequest to use group interface
This command is for a specific P2P group, not for the P2P Device
instance and as such, wpa_s pointer must not be replaced with the
interface that is used for P2P Device management.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Ilan Peer
b740401f18 P2P: Fix wpas_remove_persistent_peer() to use P2P mgmt interface
The function used wpa_s->parent->conf to iterate the P2P networks and
update the configuration file. However, wpa_s->parent is not
necessarily the interface used to manage the P2P Device operations.

Fix this by accessing the configuration file of the interface
initialized to manage the P2P Device operations.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Ilan Peer
1e0a02942b P2P: Fix wpas_p2p_add_persistent_group_client() to use P2P mgmt interface
The function used wpa_s->parent->conf to iterate the P2P networks and
update the configuration file. However, wpa_s->parent is not
necessarily the interface used to manage the P2P Device operations.

Fix this by accessing the configuration file of the interface initialized
to managed the P2P Device operations.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Ilan Peer
86b91c89af P2P: Fix wpas_p2p_set_own_freq_preference() to use P2P mgmt interface
wpas_p2p_set_own_freq_preference() accessed wpa_s->parent->conf to test
if p2p_ignore_shared_freq is set, but wpa_s->parent is not necessarily
the interface used to manage the P2P Device operations.

Fix this by accessing the configuration file of the interface
initialized to manage the P2P Device operations.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Ben Rosenfeld
43677494fb P2P: Use the P2P Device management interface in wpas_p2p_remove_client()
As wpas_p2p_remove_client() is not necessarily called from the interface
used to manage the P2P Device operations, when removing a client, use
the P2P management interface to iterate over the saved networks and
remove the relevant entries form the P2P GO network blocks.

Signed-off-by: Ben Rosenfeld <ben.rosenfeld@intel.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
7b642dc80b P2P: Add D-Bus FindStopped to notify P2P-FIND-STOPPED event
Add D-Bus notification mechanism of P2P-FIND-STOPPED event on
fi.w1.wpa_supplicant1.Interface.P2PDevice interface.

Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2015-05-25 18:31:09 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
d63f1419b5 P2P: Advertize cross connection to WLAN AP on a non-P2P interface
Commit 1c2aa04c96 ('P2P: Do not add P2P
IEs on P2P disabled interface') removed the P2P IEs from association on
non-P2P interface. However, an AP functioning as a P2P manager needs the
cross connection capability of the station (P2P Device). This needs to
be done to meet the P2P specification requirements even if the station
interface has p2p_disabled=1 in case P2P in general is enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-05-25 12:44:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c7dafdf9b0 WPS: Fix build without CONFIG_WPS=y
Commit 5add410162 ('WPS: Use shorter
authentication timeout during no-SelReg iteration') broke the build with
WPS disabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-05-24 10:33:26 +03:00
Avraham Stern
a5da657445 dbus: Stop ongoing scheduled scan when scan is requested
Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-05-03 17:34:54 +03:00
Matti Gottlieb
0c28071872 Fix sending ANQP request to an unknown BSS while associated
While being associated, if an ANQP request is received for a different
AP that doesn't exist in the BSS list, the ANQP request will be sent on
the frequency of the AP that we are currently associated to.

In such a case, it is possible that the ANQP request would be sent on
a channel different than that of the requested AP, potentially delaying
other requests/activities.

Avoid sending the ANQP request to an AP that is not in the BSS list.

Signed-off-by: Matti Gottlieb <matti.gottlieb@intel.com>
2015-05-03 17:32:32 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
74197e0adf wpa_cli: Fix memory leak when tracking networks
Fix memory leak introduced in commit
32a097fdd2 ("wpa_cli: Keep track of
available networks") by tracking networks only when in interactive mode.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2015-05-03 17:26:46 +03:00
Oren Givon
4504621f9c TDLS: Add TDLS_LINK_STATUS command to the control interface
Add the TDLS_LINK_STATUS command to the control interface. This command
shows what is the status of our current TDLS connection with the given
peer. Also, add the TDLS_LINK_STATUS command to wpa_cli.

Signed-off-by: Oren Givon <oren.givon@intel.com>
2015-05-03 17:20:24 +03:00
Eduardo Abinader
01e87ef64f IBSS: Check ibss_rsn init before starting new IBSS authentication
Sanity check added to avoid segmentation fault which occurs, when
issuing ibss_rsn ctrl iface cmd and IBSS was not initialized previously
via IBSS network selection.

Signed-off-by: Eduardo Abinader <eduardo.abinader@openbossa.org>
2015-05-03 17:15:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5aeebc48e8 D-Bus Fix network_is_persistent_group() for P2P operations
Commit c2762e410f ('P2P: Update D-Bus
network object semantics during group formation') added this helper
function to determine whether a network block is used for storing a
persistent group information. However, it implemented this in a way that
matches both persistent group storage and an operating persist group
instance. This does not seem to match the expected behavior for the
D-Bus objects, so fix this to match only the persistent group storage
case to avoid registering/unregistered incorrect D-Bus objects for
groups.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-29 20:52:22 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5441da2beb Fix wpas_notify_network_removed()
Commit bb3df9a569 ('notify: Do not raise
any signal from a P2P management interface') was supposed to only change
D-Bus behavior, but it ended up disabling non-D-Bus functionality as
well for some sequences where the P2P Device interface is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-29 20:51:14 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e8181e26ef dbus: Add a debug print on fill_dict_with_properties() getter failures
This makes it easier to debug issues with D-Bus property getter
operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-29 20:43:23 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8a78e227df D-Bus: Fix operations when P2P management interface is used
Commit 21efc940f6 ('wpa_supplicant: Do not
register a P2P management interface on DBus') hides the special P2P
management interface from D-Bus. However, it did not take into account
the possibility of wpa_s->dbus_path and wpa_s->dbus_new_path being NULL
in such cases on number of code paths within the D-Bus handlers. This
could result in invalid arguments (NULL path) being provided to D-Bus
functions (mainly, dbus_message_iter_append_basic) and NULL pointer
dereference when iterating over all interfaces. Either of these could
make wpa_supplicant process terminate.

Fix this by explicitly checking that the interface-specific D-Bus path
has been registered before using it anywhere with D-Bus handlers. In
addition, find the correct wpa_s instance to fix P2P operations through
D-Bus when the P2P Device interface is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-29 20:42:25 +03:00
Hamad Kadmany
01a025937c WPS: Add support for 60 GHz band
Handling of WPS RF band for 60 GHz was missing. Add it in all relevant
places and also map "AES" as the cipher to GCMP instead of CCMP when
operating on the 60 GHz band.

Signed-off-by: Hamad Kadmany <qca_hkadmany@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-28 00:22:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0ef1e290ab WPS: Fix shorter authentication timeout during no-SelReg iteration
Commit 5add410162 ('WPS: Use shorter
authentication timeout during no-SelReg iteration') added a new
condition on reducing the authentication timeout for the WPS AP
iteration process. However, due it ended up copy-pasting an incorrect
condition for this. This was supposed to apply for PIN-based config
method advertisement, not PBC.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-28 00:12:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a250722f38 Try to set PMK only with key mgmt offload support in the driver
Previously, it was possible for the set_key() handler to be used with
WPA_ALG_PMK even if the driver did not indicate support for key
management offload. While this is not really supposed to result in any
difference, it makes the debug logs somewhat confusing. Avoid that by
using driver capability flag for key management offload as an additional
condition for setting the PMK.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-27 16:47:07 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9f390f431c Interworking: Fix network selection warning without SIM/USIM support
interworking_credentials_available_3gpp() would have left excluded2
uninitialized without INTERWORKING_3GPP in the build. This could result
in a static analyzer warning within
interworking_credentials_available_helper() about use of uninitialized
variable. Get rid of that warning by explicitly initializing excluded2
even though this does not really result in any difference in behavior
since the excluded2 value would be used only if the non-NULL is returned
and that could not have been the case here without INTERWORKING_3GPP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-26 17:00:26 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5678a2d89b P2P: Allow wpa_supplicant to start if social channels are not supported
It was possible for an nl80211-based driver to be determined to support
P2P even when the radio supports only the 5 GHz band. This resulted in
P2P initialization failing due to not being able to pick a social
channel and wpa_supplicant not starting. Fix this by not enabling P2P,
but still allowing wpa_supplicant initialization to complete.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-26 13:59:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a6da824b19 Do not use C++ reserved words as variable names
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-26 13:36:55 +03:00
Arkadiusz (Arkq) Bokowy
eaa3728a64 wpa_gui: Themed icon loader
Signal strength meter uses non-standard icons (not included in the
freedesktop icon specification), which might not be available in all
icon sets on the market. What's more, according to the latest Ubuntu
practices, in the status-like places one should use symbolic icons.
Unfortunately not all icon sets provide them.

In order to overcome this inconsistency, we are going to try to load
more than one icon from the current theme in the fallback-like
fashion.

Signed-off-by: Arkadiusz Bokowy <arkadiusz.bokowy@gmail.com>
2015-04-26 11:55:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9a3cb4133d Fix wpa_priv (CONFIG_PRIVSEP=y) build
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-25 17:37:53 +03:00
Mikael Kanstrup
8b423edbd3 Declare all read only data structures as const
By analysing objdump output some read only structures were found in
.data section. To help compiler further optimize code declare these
as const.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-04-25 17:33:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5add410162 WPS: Use shorter authentication timeout during no-SelReg iteration
When iterating through WPS APs that do not advertise Selected Registrar
TRUE, limit the authentication timeout to 10 seconds instead of the full
70 second value used with IEEE 802.1X/EAP/WPS in general. This helps
speed up AP iteration for cases where a selected AP misbehaves and does
not reply to EAP exchanges. This should not really be needed, but there
seems to be deployed APs that do not implement WPS correctly and with
such APs in the radio range, this extra timeout can speed up the
iteration to allow the correct AP to be found before the WPS operation
times out.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-24 17:55:32 +03:00
Hu Wang
e7d20342b5 WPS: Enforce five second minimum time before AP iteration
Previously, wpa_supplicant was using number of scan iterations
(WPS_PIN_SCAN_IGNORE_SEL_REG = 3) to give some time for finding a WPS AP
with Selected Registrar TRUE before starting to iterate through all WPS
APs. While this works fine in most cases, some drivers may return the
initial three scan results so quickly that the total amount of time is
only couple of seconds in case none of the APs are initially advertising
Selected Registrar TRUE. To give some more time for APs (WPS Registrars)
to become ready, add an additional constraint on the iteration based on
time (WPS_PIN_TIME_IGNORE_SEL_REG = 5 seconds).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-24 17:55:32 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bd143cc540 Remove trailing whitespace from Makefile
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-24 01:22:15 +03:00
Ilan Peer
74802c0936 P2P: Do not create a P2P Device interface if P2P is disabled
Do not add the dedicated P2P Device interface in case P2P is disabled in
the configuration file or globally.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-04-24 01:22:15 +03:00
Ben Greear
579674ebe5 Document p2p_disabled option in wpa_supplicant.conf
I needed this option to disable P2P on a buggy system.
Document this so someone else finds it quicker next time.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-04-24 01:22:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
baae4cb9b4 Simplify HT Capabilities element parsing
Check the element length in the parser and remove the length field from
struct ieee802_11_elems since the element is of fixed length.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-22 22:05:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c9bf7b6623 Fix a memory leak on mesh_attr_text() error path
Should there not be enough room in the output buffer, the
bss_basic_rate_set line would not be printed. This error case was
handled otherwise, but the temporary memory allocation for building the
information was not freed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-22 11:44:19 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
eaa8eefed1 Replace MAX_SSID_LEN with SSID_MAX_LEN
This makes source code more consistent. The use within Android driver
interface is left as-is to avoid changes in the old PNO interface
definition.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-22 11:44:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d9d1b9527a Use SSID_MAX_LEN define instead of value 32 when comparing SSID length
This makes the implementation easier to understand.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-22 11:44:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
cc6f24380c Add WPS_DEV_NAME_MAX_LEN define and use it when comparing length
This make code easier to understand.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-22 11:44:18 +03:00
Floris Bos
8e2c5f1a20 dbus: Fix WPS property of fi.w1.wpa_supplicant1.BSS interface
The dbus interface documentation says the following about the
WPS property of the fi.w1.wpa_supplicant1.BSS interface:

==
WPS information of the BSS. Empty dictionary indicates no WPS support.
Dictionary entries are:

Type	s	"pbc", "pin", ""
==

However the implementation returns "type" => "" for BSSes
that do not support WPS.

Fix the implementation to match the documentation.
Return empty dictionary if there is no WPS support.
And "type" => "" if WPS is supported, but is not in progress
right now.

Signed-off-by: Floris Bos <bos@je-eigen-domein.nl>
2015-04-13 15:08:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b79911853f Fix CONFIG_AP=y build without CONFIG_CTRL_IFACE
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-04 11:56:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
954f03aab2 Fix compilation issues with CONFIG_NO_CONFIG_WRITE=y
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-04-04 11:52:03 +03:00
Ben Greear
da3db6812d Fix INTERFACE_ADD parsing
This fixes a regression caused by commit
efa232f915 ('Add support for virtual
interface creation/deletion') for the case where an empty extra argument
is included.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-04-04 11:02:04 +03:00
Ola Olsson
4839f7c768 wpa_cli: Fix a typo in usage text
Signed-off-by: Ola Olsson <ola.olsson@sonymobile.com>
2015-04-03 11:34:51 +03:00
Jason Abele
a20a3616cd wpa_supplicant: Clear blacklist on connect
It has been noticed that the band steering/load balancing of some
multi-AP networks will lead to an ever-growing list of blacklisted
BSSIDs. This eventually leads to a connection drop when the connection
is pushed to a distant AP.

Fix this issue by clearing the blacklist upon successful connect.

Signed-off-by: Jason Abele <jason@aether.com>
2015-04-03 10:51:36 +03:00
Dmitry Shmidt
02e122a995 Reschedule scan from wpas_stop_pno if it was postponed
This reschedules the postponed scan request (if such a request is
pending) from EVENT_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED event handler to speed up
scanning after PNO/sched_scan stop has been requested.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2015-04-01 18:21:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
56dfc4939d Fix a typo in configuration parameter documentation
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-04-01 12:57:11 +03:00
Avraham Stern
989e784601 P2P: Optimize scan frequencies list when re-joining a persistent group
When starting a P2P client to re-join a persistent group
(P2P_GROUP_ADD persistent=<id>), it is possible that the P2P GO was
already found in previous scans. Try to get the P2P GO operating
frequency from the scan results list so wpa_supplicant will initially
scan only the P2P GO known operating frequency.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-03-29 20:52:09 +03:00
Lauri Hintsala
ce18c10773 Add support for CONFIG_NO_ROAMING to Makefile
Commit e9af53ad39 introduced new
CONFIG_NO_ROAMING configuration parameter but unfortunately it was added
only to Android.mk. Enabling this parameter didn't have any effect when
Makefile was used to build wpa_supplicant. This commit fixes that problem
and cleans "unused variable" compiler warning.

Signed-off-by: Lauri Hintsala <lauri.hintsala@silabs.com>
2015-03-29 20:37:39 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
65a7b21f5e OpenSSL: Implement AES-128 CBC using EVP API
This replaces the internal CBC mode implementation in
aes_128_cbc_encrypt() and aes_128_cbc_decrypt() with the OpenSSL
implementation for CONFIG_TLS=openssl builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-29 20:30:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a52410c29f Allow PSK/passphrase to be set only when needed
The new network profile parameter mem_only_psk=1 can be used to specify
that the PSK/passphrase for that network is requested over the control
interface (ctrl_iface or D-Bus) similarly to the EAP network parameter
requests. The PSK/passphrase can then be configured temporarily in a way
that prevents it from getting stored to the configuration file.

For example:

Event:
CTRL-REQ-PSK_PASSPHRASE-0:PSK or passphrase needed for SSID test-wpa2-psk

Response:
CTRL-RSP-PSK_PASSPHRASE-0:"qwertyuiop"

Note: The response value uses the same encoding as the psk network
profile parameter, i.e., passphrase is within double quotation marks.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-28 11:05:13 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
9ccc10f56e wpa_cli: Use tab as only word separator for networks
White space is a valid SSID character so completion routine for
networks should only use tab as word separator.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-27 15:31:38 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
5a997b2f79 wpa_cli: Completion routine for dup_network command
Add command completion routine for dup_network command.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-26 22:53:37 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
1ca6c0f1f1 wpa_cli: Completion for remove, select, disable, enable network
Add command completion routines for remove_network, select_network,
disable_network, and enable_network commands.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-26 22:53:37 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
7e6cc90805 wpa_cli: Implement completion routine for get_network/set_network
Add command completion routine for get_network and set_network that
guide user with both network id and network parameters.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-26 22:53:37 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
32a097fdd2 wpa_cli: Keep track of available networks
Keep track of available networks for easy use in command completion
routines.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-26 22:53:35 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
94dc0e950d wpa_cli: Allow tab as alternative separator for cli_txt_list words
To be able to reuse the add/del word utility functions for lines containing
tabs allow both space and tab as word separators.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-26 22:36:12 +02:00
Jithu Jance
efa232f915 Add support for virtual interface creation/deletion
Extend interface_add and interface_remove commands via an optional
argument to allow wpa_supplicant to create/delete a new virtual
interface.

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2015-03-26 22:20:35 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
ba87329d96 wpa_cli: Use .wpa_cli_history under Android
wpa_cli already implements a command history file for easy accessing
commands previously used. Enable the functionality on Android, too.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-26 15:29:13 +02:00
Ben Greear
0f8385e6fa Show OSEN key management properly in scan results
Old code defaulted to WEP for an AP advertising OSEN. Show as OSEN
instead. Re-use most of the RSN parsing logic since all but the header
is the same.

Example output:

[root@ath9k-f lanforge]# ./local/bin/wpa_cli -i sta0 scan_results
bssid / frequency / signal level / flags / ssid
00:0e:8e:6f:40:49	2462	-23	[OSEN-OSEN-CCMP][ESS]	ben-138

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-03-25 16:04:03 +02:00
Arkadiusz (Arkq) Bokowy
e7b4cd0c55 wpa_gui: Add tray icon based signal strength meter
System tray icon can be set to 5 different pictographs according to the
connection status. One for disconnected state (not associated with the
network, or not connected with the wpa_supplicant service), and four for
connected status (showing the signal strength on the receiver).

By default this functionality is disabled. The reason for this, is the
fact, that the underlaying approach of this functionality is poll based,
which might be considered as a non-efficient one. Update interval has to
be set explicitly by the user with '-m<seconds>' command line argument.

Status icon names are based on various Gnome icon packs (e.g., Faba).
When icon can not be found, default one is shown (wpa_gui logo).

Signed-off-by: Arkadiusz Bokowy <arkadiusz.bokowy@gmail.com>
2015-03-25 15:41:15 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
c41d0840a1 nl80211: Allow driver-based roam to change ESS
This extends NL80211_CMD_ROAM event processing to allow the driver to
roam to another ESS (different SSID) when using offloaded BSS selection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-24 21:13:28 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0fd52a612a Remove duplicated wpa_s->conf->interworking check
wpas_add_interworking_elements() does not need to do this since the
caller is already checking whether Interworking is enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-22 21:48:41 +02:00
Ilan Peer
ad4430971f Add Extended Capabilities element to all Probe Request frames
Always add the Extended Capabilities element to Probe Request frames (in
case it is not all zeros) to publish support for driver advertised
capabilities and wpa_supplicant specific capabilities.

This also fixes the case where Extended Capabilities element was added
for Interworking cases, but did not use the driver advertised ones and
did not handle other capabilities supported by wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-03-22 21:48:38 +02:00
Avraham Stern
9bd566a33a Delay AP selection if all networks are temporarily disabled
If all networks are temporarily disabled, delay AP selection until at
least one network is enabled. Running AP selection when all networks are
disabled is useless as wpa_supplicant will not try to connect. In
addition, it will result in needless scan iterations that may delay the
connection when it is needed.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-03-22 20:53:58 +02:00
Avraham Stern
701f3961e3 Don't optimize scan frequencies if selected network has changed
When disconnecting from a BSS, the next scan is optimized to scan only
the channels used by the connected ESS. But when disconnecting because a
new network was selected, this optimization is wrong because
wpa_supplicant is now trying to connect to another ESS. Fix this by not
optimizing the scan frequencies in case the selected network has
changed.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-03-22 20:36:01 +02:00
Max Stepanov
e9d280503a P2PS: Extend p2p_service_del asp to support 'all' parameter
Extend p2p_service_del asp command to support 'all' parameter to delete
all ASP service advertisements.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Max Stepanov
6dd51ecbf1 P2PS: Add P2PS advertisements on ALL_SERVICES ANQP query
Add P2PS advertisements to a query response on ANQP query of
ALL_SERVICES type.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Max Stepanov
c40a8918ec P2PS: Delete ASP advertisements on wpas_p2p_service_flush
Delete all ASP serice advertisement on wpas_p2p_service_flush similarly
to Bonjour and UPnP services.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Max Stepanov
2dc422e2b3 P2PS: Update SD indicator value on ASP add/del/update
Update a service update indicator value on ASP service advertisement
add/del/update operations.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Victor Goldenshtein
6ceea4c3cb Restart sched_scan on channel list change
The channel list can be changed as a result of arriving beacon hints
during normal scan or as a result of local Reg-Domain change. Some
passive channels can become active and needs to be reconfigured
accordingly for the scheduled scan.

This fixes the connection to hidden SSIDs on 5 GHz band during default
Reg-Domain 00 (world roaming).

Signed-off-by: Victor Goldenshtein <victorg@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Eliad Peller
e7a296ba13 Remove unused shared_freq driver op
This driver op is not used anymore

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
55e8f0eafc Fix CONFIG_EAP_UNAUTH_TLS without CONFIG_EAP_TLS build
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:59 +02:00
Neelansh Mittal
9772af66ba Interworking: Prevent scan during ANQP fetch and Interworking select
Reject external scan request while either ANQP fetch or Interworking
select is in progress. Not doing so could lead to a situation in which
Interworking automatic network selection does not get triggered because
of a new scan result event forcing the ANQP fetch cycle to be disrupted
and restarted all over again. Interworking automatic network selection
is only triggered when AQNP fetch cycle, that is, ANQP exchange with
every Interworking capable BSS in the current BSS list, is completed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-20 15:56:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6784168d07 Remove SChannel support
SChannel/CryptoAPI as a TLS/crypto library alternative was never
completed. Critical functionality is missing and there are bugs in this
implementation. Since there are no known plans of completing this
support, it is better to remove this code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-18 22:31:36 +02:00
Arkadiusz (Arkq) Bokowy
0b08f25445 wpa_gui: Documentation update
In the commit 77b244d577a7cb5c928478627af6687a0733193d9 ('wpa_gui: Quiet
mode - disable tray icon messages') a new parameter has been introduced,
but it was not documented. This commit fixes this omission.

Signed-off-by: Arkadiusz Bokowy <arkadiusz.bokowy@gmail.com>
2015-03-16 12:30:12 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
8ffaafae07 wpa_cli: Add missing parameters for "set" command completion routine
Some config parameters were missing in the "set" command completion
routine. Add missing parameters and while at it put the parameters
under compiler switches so only valid ones are shown.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-15 21:00:57 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
0fd9d95fde wpa_cli: Add completion routine for "get" command
Add tab completion function that includes all available "get"
parameters.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-15 21:00:17 +02:00
Mikael Kanstrup
5c6c315fba Add IPv4 support function for "get" control interface command
Add support to retrieve IPv4 config variables with the "get" control
interface command. This allows the ip_addr_* parameters for P2P+NFC
IP address assignment to be fetched from the GO.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2015-03-15 20:57:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
74fa78b281 Add AVG_BEACON_RSSI to SIGNAL_POLL output
If the driver reports separate signal strength average for Beacon
frames, report that in SIGNAL_POLL output.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-15 20:45:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0f89328575 P2P: Move upper layer SD interaction into a separate file
wpa_supplicant/p2p_supplicant.c has reached almost 10000 lines in length
and was getting a bit inconvenient to edit, so start splitting it into
separate files.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-15 20:25:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bc1d23ae1d Add ChangeLog entries for v2.4
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-14 16:51:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f10487e1af Send CTRL-EVENT-DISCONNECTED on wpa_supplicant AP deinit
This makes the AP mode more consistent with other modes by providing a
matching pair of CTRL-EVENT-CONNECTED and CTRL-EVENT-DISCONNECTED event
messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-14 10:05:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d246a1db9 Make rate-not-supported debug print more useful
It looks like "hardware does not support required rate 1.0 Mbps" has
started showing up in some hwsim test cases as a reason for failure.
This should not really occur with mac80211_hwsim, so add more details to
the debug print to make it easier to figure out what exactly happened.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-07 15:35:40 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
c10ca2a66f TDLS: Allow driver to request TDLS Discovery Request initiation
This extends the TDLS operation request mechanism to allow TDLS
Discovery Request to be initiated by the driver similarly to the
existing Setup and Teardown requests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 21:08:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
41312fc7ef mesh: Leave mesh in driver setup if initialization fails
It was possible to leave the driver in mesh point state if upper layer
mesh initialization failed in wpa_supplicant_mesh_init(). With nl80211,
this results in the vif being left in mesh point mode instead of
restoring it to station mode. That seems to break normal functionality,
e.g., for Public Action frame TX/RX. Fix this by restoring station mode
on mesh failure path.

This error could be triggered, e.g., with the following hwsim test case
sequence: wpas_mesh_secure_sae_missing_password
nfc_p2p_static_handover_tagdev_go_forced_freq

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 20:58:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6e9023ea49 DFS: Allow wpa_supplicant AP mode to use non-offloaded DFS
This extends the hostapd-like setup of DFS-in-userspace for
wpa_supplicant AP mode operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:25:13 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
bd0f68c473 DFS: wpa_supplicant event processing
Add radar event processing logic for AP/P2P GO. The DFS processing
functions from hostapd are now used for these wpa_supplicant cases as
well for both offloaded and non-offloaded DFS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:24:16 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
d7f1aa8fd7 DFS offload: P2P changes for autonomous GO
Add P2P changes to allow bringing up P2P autonomous GO on a DFS channel
if DFS functionality is offloaded to the driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:24:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
192ad3d730 Interworking: Clear SCANNING state if no match found
Previously, it was possible for wpa_state to be left at SCANNING if
INTERWORKING_SELECT command failed to find any match. Now the state is
set to DISCONNECTED if the operation terminates because of no matching
networks.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-03 17:03:25 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
95d7b863ec P2P: Consider 5 GHz channels also for auto GO
When there is no channel preference mentioned by user, auto GO
can be started on any of the 5 GHz channels supported for P2P.
Consider operating classes 115 and 124 which do not require DFS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-02 17:01:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a51c40aa35 P2P: Fix regression in start-GO/AP through a "fake" scan
Commit 3f9ebc439c ('P2P: Allow AP/GO
interface to be started while P2P-in-progress') moved the
wpa_s->connect_without_scan and wpa_s->last_scan_req checks to an
earlier place within the wpa_supplicant_scan() function without
adjusting wpa_s->last_scan_req. This variable was set between the old
and new location, so the new location needs to use wpa_s->scan_req.

This fixes an issue where AP/GO operations were not properly started in
some operation sequence. Instead, a station mode scan was executed. This
issue could be triggered, e.g., by running the no_go_freq test case
followed by autogo_random_channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-02 16:45:51 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
dd5c155e2e eap_proxy: Callback to notify any updates from eap_proxy
This commit introduces a callback to notify any configuration updates
from the eap_proxy layer. This is used to trigger re-reading of IMSI and
MNC length.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-02 12:47:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9feadba141 Remove unnecessary NULL check to make function more consistent
Static analyzers may warn about dereference before NULL check in
wpas_network_disabled() due to the new code added to check
wpa_s->p2p_mgmt. wpa_s cannot be NULL here, so remove the unneeded check
for it later in the function. (CID 106124)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 22:36:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1772d348ea P2P: Fix interface deinit for failed group interface initialization
wpa_supplicant_deinit_iface() ends up removing all P2P groups if the
removed interface is the parent interface. This is correct behavior in
general, but this resulted in issues in the new group interface
initialization error path since wpa_s->parent was not assigned before
hitting this check. Fix this by assigning wpa_s->parent as part of
wpa_supplicant_add_iface().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 22:36:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3f9ebc439c P2P: Allow AP/GO interface to be started while P2P-in-progress
Do not delay the "station mode scan" that is not really a scan, but a
request to start AP/GO mode operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 22:36:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c28059091a Do not add blacklist entries based on normal disconnect request cases
There are number of cases where wpa_supplicant requests the current
connection to be disconnected before starting a new operation. Such
cases do not really indicate that there was an error in connecting or a
disconnection initiated by the AP, so do not add a temporary blacklist
entry in such sequences.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 15:54:24 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bdf0518bb9 P2P: Direct P2P_CONNECT command to proper interface
It is possible for the P2P_CONNECT control interface command to be
issued on an incorrect interface. While the upper layer component should
really use global control interface for this, make this work by
redirecting the command to the correct context if needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 11:54:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
44b9ea5bb2 P2P: Do not allow scan or normal association on cfg80211 P2P Device
The dedicated P2P management instance (wpas->p2p_mgmt == 1) using
cfg80211 P2P Device cannot be used for non-P2P uses or connection (there
is no netdev). Reject or ignore such operations to avoid unexpected
operations if enabled network blocks are configured in the
wpa_supplicant instance used to control this interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 11:23:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9542f21f3a Clean up p2p_find command parsing and execution
There is no need to maintain three almost identical copies of the
wpas_p2p_find() call.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 21:58:38 +02:00
Daisuke Niwa
fa9f381f20 P2P: Allow a specific channel to be specified in P2P_FIND
The optional freq=<MHz> can now be used with the P2P_FIND command to
specify a single channel to scan during the first round of P2P search.
For example, this can be used to replace the full initial scan with a
single channel scan of a known operation channel.

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2015-02-28 21:52:56 +02:00
Daichi Ueura
eb78a8d5e3 P2P: Restore P2P_SCAN_SPECIFIC
This reverts commit 3df2f4fe99 ('P2P:
Remove unused P2P_SCAN_SPECIFIC') with a modification to fit the current
code base.

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2015-02-28 21:41:38 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
c3dabf5a00 Fix merge issue with IBSS VHT support
Commit 563ee1832b ('IBSS: Add support for
VHT80 configuration') got merged in incorrectly with one i/j swap
missed.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-28 16:48:22 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8b2b718da9 Fix minor issue in HT40 max rate determination
Commit a1b790eb9d ('Select AP based on
estimated maximum throughput') had a copy-paste bug than ended up
leaving one of the max_ht40_rate() cases unreachable. (CID 106087)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 16:40:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0d2030ee20 Use estimated throughput to improve roaming selection
Previously, within-ESS roaming was skipped if the selected BSS did not
have a higher signal strength than the current BSS regardless of AP
capabilities. This could result in not moving to a BSS that would
provide higher throughput, e.g., due to larger channel bandwidth or
higher rates (HT/VHT MCS).

Use estimated throughput information from scan result processing to
allow within-ESS roaming if the selected BSS is likely to provide better
throughput even if the current BSS has larger RSSI.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 11:45:45 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d747e2a98 Add snr and est_throughput to the BSS entries
These values were previously used only for sorting the scan results, but
it may be useful to provide access to the used values through the BSS
entries.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 11:09:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a1b790eb9d Select AP based on estimated maximum throughput
This modifies the BSS selection routines to calculate SNR and estimated
throughput for each scan result and then use the estimated throughput as
a criteria for sorting the results. This extends the earlier design by
taking into account higher throughput rates if both the AP and local
device supports HT20, HT40, or VHT80. In addition, the maximum rate is
restricted based on SNR.

In practice, this gives significantly higher probability of selecting
HT/VHT APs when there are multiple BSSes in the same ESS and SNR is not
low enough to prevent higher MCS use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 11:09:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ab647ffea7 Add wpa_supplicant Makefile target libwpa_ctrl.a
"make -C wpa_supplicant libwpa_ctrl.a" can now be used to build a static
library that can be linked with external programs using wpa_ctrl.h. This
makes it easier to create a separate library package that does not
depend in any other hostap.git file other than src/common/wpa_ctrl.h and
the libwpa_ctrl.a built with this new make target.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-21 17:48:10 +02:00
Matthieu Mauger
71d77adb6d Update current BSS level when signal change event occurs
When an EVENT_SIGNAL_CHANGE occurs the bgscan is informed about this
change but the new RSSI value is not stored. In consequence, when
roaming candidates are evaluated, the RSSI value of the current BSS used
to compare is an old one obtained during the last scan rather than the
new one given by the signal change event. This leads sometimes to bad
decision when selecting a new BSS for roaming.

This patch solves the issue by updating the current BSS level when
receiving a signal change event in order to have a very up-to-date
current signal value when choosing an new BSS.

Signed-off-by: Matthieu Mauger <matthieux.mauger@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Ilan Peer
f1609f119a wpa_supplicant: Cancel sched_scan when stopping countermeasures
When stopping the TKIP countermeasures, it would be preferable to
connect immediately. However if scheduled scan is in progress,
a connection attempt will be done only when scan results are received,
so cancel the scheduled scan to allow immediate scan and connection
attempt.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Eliad Peller
0b8bcaa50f P2P: Allow configuring CTWindow when working as GO
Read p2p_go_ctwindow (0-127 TUs) from the config file, and pass it to
the driver on GO start.

Use p2p_go_ctwindow=0 (no CTWindow) by default.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
ASHUTOSH NARAYAN
5ce6ac11ab Inteworking: Add support to update the ANQP Capability List into the BSS
In addition, add support for returning the capability list through
the BSS control interface command.

Signed-off-by: ASHUTOSH NARAYAN <ashutoshx.narayan@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
ASHUTOSH NARAYAN
185ada4770 HS 2.0: Add support to update the HS20 Capability List into the BSS
In addition, add support for returning the capability list through the
BSS control interface command.

Signed-off-by: ASHUTOSH NARAYAN <ashutoshx.narayan@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Arkadiusz (Arkq) Bokowy
7fe7a3a51f wpa_gui: Debug enhancement
Instead of calling a dummy printf function use preprocessor to determine
if debugging mode is enabled. Also use native Qt debug function.

Signed-off-by: Arkadiusz Bokowy <arkadiusz.bokowy@gmail.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2b892d442a Add forgotten network profile parameters to config file writing
Number of network profile parameters were not written to the
configuration file.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
563ee1832b IBSS: Add support for VHT80 configuration
Configure VHT80 based on driver capabilities.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
98479dc95e IBSS: Update operating frequency if joining an existing IBSS
If a matching IBSS is found in scan results, change requested frequency
to match and disable OBSS scan.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
4d9e6fba2a IBSS: Add fixed_freq network parameter
Add fixed_freq=<0/1> network block parameter and pass it to the driver
when starting or joining an IBSS. If this flag is set, IBSS should not
try to look for other IBSS networks to merge with on different channels.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Dmitry Shmidt
6f5e1b0bf6 Use priority list instead of global for PNO
Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:52 +02:00
Rajiv Ranjan
f92446fb7d P2PS: Add P2PS interface info
This adds documentation on P2PS related interface commands and events.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-21 11:28:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
59b416c733 Add optional reassoc-to-same-BSS optimization
The new reassoc_same_bss_optim=1 configuration parameter can now be used
to request wpa_supplicant to bypass the unnecessary Authentication frame
exchange when reassociating back to the same BSS with which the device
is already associated. This functionality is disabled by default since
it may cause undesired interoperability issues with some APs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-19 16:35:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c4da67deef Fix passive_scan config parameter writing
Commit c35e35ed81 ('Add passive_scan
configuration parameter') used incorrect parameter name when writing the
passive_scan parameter into a configuration file.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-19 16:22:47 +02:00
Ola Olsson
10263dc2a4 Add control interface commands for fetching wpa_config values
The new "DUMP" and "SET <variable>" control interface commands can be
used to fetch global wpa_supplicant configuration parameters.

Signed-off-by: Ola Olsson <ola.olsson@sonymobile.com>
2015-02-08 22:49:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f91a512f1f Add INTERWORKING_ADD_NETWORK command
This can be used to provide more control to upper layers on network
blocks generated as part of Interworking network selection.
INTERWORKING_ADD_NETWORK behaves otherwise identically to
INTERWORKING_CONNECT, but it does not request a new connection after
having added the network block and it returns the network id of the
added network.

INTERWORKING_ADD_NETWORK followed by REASSOCIATE would behave more or
less identically to INTERWORKING_CONNECT, but this allows the created
network profile to be modified, if desired, and/or stored externally.
SELECT_NETWORK can also be used with the network id returned from
INTERWORKING_ADD_NETWORK to enforce that specific network profile to be
used for the next connection (though, it should be noted that this
behavior may not meet all Hotspot 2.0 requirements if there were other
enabled networks that could have higher priority).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 22:49:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5b74e086e6 P2P: Document P2P_CONNECT-auto
Commit b31be3a0fd ('P2P: Add automatic GO
Negotiation vs. join-a-group selection') added this P2P_CONNECT 'auto'
parameter, but did not update any documentation on it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 13:35:50 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
99650cadc9 Add STOP_AP control interface command
This is mainly for testing purposes to allow beaconing to be stopped
without clearing AP state in hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 13:35:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6b00512164 P2P: Add event messages for P2P_CONNECT-fallback-to-GO-Neg
This makes it easier for upper layer programs to follow progress of
P2P_CONNECT-auto operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 13:35:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b0e669beeb P2P: Fix P2P_CONNECT-auto fallback to GO Neg with group interface
If a separate P2P group interface was used, P2P_CONNECT-auto fallback to
GO Negotiation could result in use of freed memory and segmentation
fault. This happened in cases where the peer GO was found in some old
scans, but not in the first scan triggered by the P2P_CONNECT-auto
command ("P2P: Peer was found running GO in older scan -> try to join
the group" shows up in the debug log). In addition, the GO would still
need to reply to PD Request to allow this code path to be triggered.

When five scans for the GO were completed in this sequence, the P2P
group interface was removed as part of falling back to GO Negotiation.
However, that ended up dereferencing the freed wpa_s instance at the end
of scan event processing. Fix this by reordering code a bit and breaking
out from EVENT_SCAN_RESULTS processing if the interface could have been
removed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 13:35:14 +02:00
Masashi Honma
bf51f4f82b mesh: Fix remaining BLOCKED state after SAE auth failure
When SAE authentication fails, wpa_supplicant retries four times. If all
the retries result in failure, SAE state machine enters BLOCKED state.
Once it enters this state, wpa_supplicant doesn't retry connection. This
commit allow connection retries even if the state machine entered
BLOCKED state.

There could be an opinion "Is this patch needed? User could know the SAE
state machine is in the BLOCKED mode by MESH-SAE-AUTH-BLOCKED event.
Then user can retry connection. By user action, SAE state machine can
change the state from BLOCKED to another.". Yes, this is a true at the
joining mesh STA. However, a STA that is already a member of existing
mesh BSS should not retry connection because if the joining mesh STA
used wrong password, all the existing STA should do something from UI to
retry connection.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-02-08 12:43:24 +02:00
Masashi Honma
79ddb2062e mesh: Add a monitor event on SAE authentication getting blocked
Send MESH-SAE-AUTH-BLOCKED event if SAE authentication is blocked. The
BLOCK state will finish when a new peer notification event is sent for
the same MAC address.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-02-07 22:33:23 +02:00
Masashi Honma
dd2cbafc89 mesh: Add a monitor event for SAE authentication failure
SAE authentication fails likely with wrong password. This commit adds a
notification of the failure to the upper application (UI) so that the
application can notify suspection of a wrong password to the user. The
control interface monitor even for this is "MESH-SAE-AUTH-FAILURE
addr=<peer>".

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-02-07 22:23:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
11e2ddbcd7 mesh: Remove duplicated no_auto_peer update
Commit 07cb45ccb2 ('mesh: Add no_auto_peer
config option') added a new struct wpa_ssid argument and added an
unnecessary parsing and setting of the value in
wpa_supplicant_ctrl_iface_update_network(). This is not needed since
wpa_config_set() takes care of parsing the parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-07 16:19:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1e529832a8 D-Bus: Fix network block type change
It is possible for a network profile to change its type from P2P
persistent group to a normal network and back. The D-Bus interface uses
different types of objects for those, so the object needs to
re-registered in case of type change. This fixes issues in leaving
behind an incorrect type of object and leaking memory when freeing such
a network block that has had its disabled parameter changed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-07 16:19:08 +02:00
Vinit Deshpande
663ae2f417 Don't write to wpa_supplicant.conf directly
There is a chance that wpa_supplicant may get killed during
the time it is writing config file. If this happens, user
information like SSIDs and passwords can be lost forever.

This change works around that by writing config to a
temporary file and then renaming the file to the correct name.

Signed-off-by: Vinit Deshpande <vinitd@google.com>
2015-02-07 15:37:13 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
d9a9bc04b4 IBSS: Do not enable HT with WEP or TKIP
We should not enable HT if WEP or TKIP is configured.
Without the patch and WEP configuration we will get message:
Association request to the driver failed

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-06 21:43:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
abe96d0605 P2P: Clean up Listen channel optimization debug prints
Do not claim to change the Listen channel in a debug message when
previously configured channel prevents this. In addition, fix a typo in
another related debug print.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 16:13:35 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
93eca6155b P2PS: Do not remove pending interface on p2p_stop_find
The pending interface created during provision discovery should
not be removed on stopping p2p_find. This pending interface has
to be used after completing GO negotiation. Earlier the pending
interface is created just before GO negotiation so there was no
problem.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
87d5ef5a41 P2PS: Add commands to control interface redir list
This is needed to allow P2PS related new control interface commands to
be redirected for proper context processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
306aaf49f8 P2PS: Start WPS registrar upon GO formation
If P2PS config method is used for provisioning, upon forming a new GO,
start WPS registrar for the provisioned peer automatically.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
ab8ee776b9 P2PS: Provision Discovery fail event
This extends P2P-PROV-DISC-FAILURE with adv_id and deferred_session_resp
in P2PS cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
1300cc8e8f P2PS: PD Request processing and PD Response building
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
5fefce2747 P2PS: Callback to send P2PS provisioning events
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
9a58e521ac P2PS: Callback to create pending group after sending PD Response
This introduces a P2P module callback function that will be used to
create the pending P2PS group after sending PD Response and receiving
ACK status for it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
895d94def9 P2PS: Callback to remove stale persistent groups
When the peer device is trying to form a new group despite having
old persistent group with same roles, remove the stale persistent
group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
f309c18e50 P2PS: ASP provisioning commands to control interface
This adds new wpa_supplicant control interface commands
P2P_ASP_PROVISION and P2P_ASP_PROVISION_RESP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
6d9085145c P2PS: Process P2PS provisioning commands
This extends wpas_p2p_prov_disc() implementation to accept P2PS
parameters. None of the callers are yet using this functionality; the
following commit introduces a user.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
369678ad14 P2PS: Add P2PS attributes into PD Request if requested
This adds a data structure for storing P2PS PD information and code to
add the related attributes into PD Request. The actual operation to
trigger this behavior will be added in a separate commit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
d4b43b5886 P2PS: Add support to send ASP-RESP events
Send P2P-SERV-ASP-RESP events upon receiving GAS responses with
ASP services.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
6df08d0341 P2PS: Logic to parse GAS requests for ASP services
Add support to parse received GAS requests for ASP services and
prepare GAS responses accordingly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
5a4102ce0e P2PS: Add support to send ASP service requests
This extends the P2P_SERV_DISC_REQ control interface command with a new
"asp" service type. This takes service id, service string, and optional
service info as arguments.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Brian Gix
095b3c4069 P2PS: Add Application Service Info to device found events
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
ae9d45f329 P2PS: Extend add/del services logic to support ASP
In addition, add a new P2P_SERVICE_REP command that can be used to
replace existing ASP advertisements.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Brian Gix
4f88fc0464 P2PS: WPS changes needed for P2PS default PIN
This provides additional WPS definitions and rules for negotiating use
of P2PS default PIN configuration method.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 16:55:45 +02:00
Brian Gix
5177509657 P2PS: Add option to specify seek strings into P2P_FIND
P2PS seek strings can now be specified in the P2P_FIND control interface
command with one or more optional "seek=<str>" parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 16:55:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
66eaf8a2c2 Fix driver-offloaded offchannel TX done processing
It was possible for a Action frame sequence completion to stop an
ongoing offchannel remain-on-channel operation unexpectedly in cases
where TX operation was offloaded to the driver and such an operation
happened to occur during a previously started remain-on-channel (e.g.,
for P2P listen state).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f2dc06e2bd P2P: Ignore remain-on-channel callback event if not waiting for one
It was possible for the previously requested remain-on-channel for P2P
listen state to get canceled before having received driver event
indicating start of that remain-on-channel operation. In such a case,
the event was able to trigger P2P module to start processing listen
timeout even though there was not supposed to be a following listen
operation anymore. Skip the driver event if we are not waiting for a new
listen state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:18 +02:00
Mukesh Agrawal
f0d0a5d23b Improve BSS selection with default noise floor values
When noise floor measurements are not available, compute SNR
using default values for the noise floor. This helps steer us
towards 5 GHz BSSes in high signal strength environments.

In more detail...

Existing code prefers a 5 GHz BSS when the 5 GHz BSS's signal
strength is "close" to that of the 2.4 GHz BSS, or when both SNRs
are large. However, the mwifiex driver does not provide noise
floor measurements, so we can't compute SNRs.

Because mwifiex doesn't provide NF measurements, the "large SNR"
code wasn't effective. By using default values for the noise floor,
we can again compute SNRs, and decide that the SNR is high enough
that we shouldn't worry about the exact difference in SNR.

The default noise floor values (one for 2.4 GHz, and one for 5 GHz)
were chosen by measurement in a noisy environment, so they should be
conservative.

Note that while this patch is motivated by mwifiex, it affects
ath9k as well. Although ath9k provides noise floor measurements
in general, it will sometimes fail to provide a measurement for
one or more specific channels.

As a result of this patch, we'll always compare BSSes based on SNR
(either measured or estimated), rather than sometimes comparing
based on signal strength. ("Always" assumes that the
WPA_SCAN_LEVEL_DBM flag is set. It is for mwifiex and ath9k.)

While there:
- fix a whitespace issue (spaces -> tab)
- clean up existing comments
- update dump_scan_res to indicate whether the noise floor is
  measured, or default

Signed-hostap: mukesh agrawal <quiche@chromium.org>
2015-02-01 22:01:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7f7bfba919 Add an option allow canned EAP-Success for wired IEEE 802.1X
For wired IEEE 802.1X authentication, phase1="allow_canned_success=1"
can now be used to configure a mode that allows EAP-Success (and
EAP-Failure) without going through authentication step. Some switches
use such sequence when forcing the port to be authorized/unauthorized or
as a fallback option if the authentication server is unreachable. By
default, wpa_supplicant discards such frames to protect against
potential attacks by rogue devices, but this option can be used to
disable that protection for cases where the server/authenticator does
not need to be authenticated.

When enabled, this mode allows EAP-Success/EAP-Failure as an immediate
response to EAPOL-Start (or even without EAPOL-Start) and EAP-Success is
also allowed immediately after EAP-Identity exchange (fallback case for
authenticator not being able to connect to authentication server).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-01 19:22:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
49fcc32e91 EAP-MSCHAPv2 peer: Add option to disable password retry query
wpa_supplicant used to request user to re-enter username/password if the
server indicated that EAP-MSCHAPv2 (e.g., in PEAP Phase 2)
authentication failed (E=691), but retry is allowed (R=1). This is a
reasonable default behavior, but there may be cases where it is more
convenient to close the authentication session immediately rather than
wait for user to do something.

Add a new "mschapv2_retry=0" option to the phase2 field to allow the
retry behavior to be disabled. This will make wpa_supplicant abort
authentication attempt on E=691 regardless of whether the server allows
retry.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-01 17:45:19 +02:00
Ben Greear
99805a0ea1 Interworking: Convert wpa_printf() to wpa_msg()
Also adds a few messages that helped me track down why things
were not working as expected.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-02-01 01:32:25 +02:00
Roger Zanoni
b42f539ed2 Add a variable to handle extra CFLAGS values
Some packages don't install its headers in the default directory
(e.g.: In Arch Linux libiberty and libn13 includes are installed)
in their own subdirectory under /usr/include) and the build fails
trying to find the headers.

This patch will allow passing extra CFLAGS values without discarding
the assignments made in the Makefile. The CFLAGS values in the Makefile
are ignored, if defined directly in the make command line.

Signed-off-by: Roger Zanoni <roger.zanoni@openbossa.org>
2015-02-01 00:26:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e6dd8196e5 Work around Linux packet socket regression
Linux kernel commit 576eb62598f10c8c7fd75703fe89010cdcfff596 ('bridge:
respect RFC2863 operational state') from 2012 introduced a regression
for using wpa_supplicant with EAPOL frames and a station interface in a
bridge. Since it does not look like this regression is going to get
fixed any time soon (it is already two years from that commit and over
1.5 from a discussion pointing out the regression), add a workaround in
wpa_supplicant to avoid this issue.

The wpa_supplicant workaround uses a secondary packet socket to capture
all frames (ETH_P_ALL) from the netdev that is in a bridge. This is
needed to avoid the kernel regression. However, this comes at the price
of more CPU load. Some of this is avoided with use of Linux socket
filter, but still, this is less efficient than a packet socket bound to
the specific EAPOL ethertype. The workaround gets disabled
automatically, if the main packet socket interface on the bridge
interface turns out to be working for RX (e.g., due to an old kernel
version being used or a new kernel version having a fix for the
regression). In addition, this workaround is only taken into use for the
special case of running wpa_supplicant with an interface in a bridge.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-31 17:21:58 +02:00
Bob Copeland
745d93695b mesh: Create new station entry on popen frames
Currently, there is a race in open mesh networks where mesh STA A
receives a beacon from B and sends a peering open frame to initiate
peering. STA B, having not yet received a beacon from A and thus
created the corresponding station entry, will ignore all such open
frames. If the beacon interval is sufficiently long then peering
will not succeed as a result.

In fact B can simply create the station entry when the popen is
received, as is done in Linux's in-kernel MPM, avoiding the issue.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Bob Copeland
41bff862d9 mesh: Always free the station if peering failed
Previously, we would only free the station entry if a peering close
frame was received (freeing the station entry causes the kernel to
start sending peer candidate events again when suitable beacons are
received, triggering peering or authentication to restart).

The end result is the same in any case regardless of close reason:
if we leave holding state then peering has started again, so go
ahead and remove the station in all cases.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Masashi Honma
871ff0b746 mesh: Sync plink state with kernel
The plink_state exists both wpa_supplicant and kernel. Synchronize them
with wpa_mesh_set_plink_state().

Signed-off-by: Kenzoh Nishikawa <Kenzoh.Nishikawa@jp.sony.com>
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ba4226130e Simplify eapol_sm_notify_pmkid_attempt()
Drop the unneeded 'attempt' argument. This was originally used for
indicating an aborted PMKID caching attempt, but a fix in 2006 removed
the only such user and since that time, only attempt == 1 has been used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
993a865407 Add eap_session_id to wpa_supplicant STATUS output
This makes the current EAP Session-Id available for external programs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f19c907822 OpenSSL: Implement aes_wrap() and aes_unwrap()
This replaces the implementation in aes-wrap.c and aes-unwrap.c with
OpenSSL AES_wrap_key() and AES_unwrap_key() functions when building
hostapd or wpa_supplicant with OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
983c6a606b OpenSSL: Replace internal HMAC-MD5 implementation
Use OpenSSL HMAC_* functions to implement HMAC-MD5 instead of depending
on the src/crypto/md5.c implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3f56a2b746 Ignore pmf=1 default if driver does not support PMF
Connection with a PMF enabled AP will fail if we try to negotiate PMF
while the local driver does not support this. Since pmf=1 does not
require PMF for a successful connection, it can be ignored in such a
case to avoid connectivity issues with invalid configuration. This makes
it somewhat easier to allow upper layer programs to use pmf=1 default
regardless of driver capabilities.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 12:38:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
937403b581 Update copyright notices for the new year 2015
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:43:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
399e61353a Add Suite B AKMs to key_mgmt capability list
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:43:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5e3b5197cc Add Suite B 192-bit AKM
WPA-EAP-SUITE-B-192 can now be used to select 192-bit level Suite B into
use as the key management method.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:43:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
97ae35a848 Add HMAC-SHA384
For now, this is only implemented with OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:26:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
98cd3d1c3b Preparations for variable length KCK and KEK
This modifies struct wpa_ptk to allow the length of KCK and KEK to be
stored. This is needed to allow longer keys to be used, e.g., with
Suite B 192-bit level.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:26:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b5f045deee Show supported group_mgmt capabilities
This extends GET_CAPABILITY command to allow the supported group
management frame cipher suites to be listed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-24 19:37:42 +02:00
Ben Greear
893e152e64 Interworking: More debug messages
And convert some wpa_printf to wpa_msg.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-01-24 19:37:42 +02:00
Ben Greear
f45bae5b81 Interworking: Add logging to track nai_realm_find_eap failures
There are lots of reasons we can fail to match an EAP credential, so add
logging to help determine why it is happening in various cases.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-01-24 19:37:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5a5aab7f40 Interworking: Remove unnecessary NULL check
nai_realm_find_eap() is called only in cases where the cred pointer is
not NULL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-24 19:37:42 +02:00
Adrian Nowicki
ad905e4a79 wpa_gui: Sort frequency and signal numerically in the scan results dialog
Signal strength was sorted lexically rather than numerically, which
put "-100 dBm" before "-50 dBm" if sorted in descending order.
This change fixes that. It also treats frequency in the same
manner, preparing it for the IEEE 802.11ah.

Signed-off-by: Adrian Nowicki <adinowicki@gmail.com>
2015-01-23 01:24:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c35e35ed81 Add passive_scan configuration parameter
This new wpa_supplicant configuration parameter can be used to force
passive scanning to be used for most scanning cases at the cost of
increased latency and less reliably scans. This may be of use for both
testing purposes and somewhat increased privacy due to no Probe Request
frames with fixed MAC address being sent out.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-22 20:50:01 +02:00
ASHUTOSH NARAYAN
fb09ed3389 Interworking: Notify the ANQP parsing status
The ANQP verification/parsing is done only after the GAS_DONE indication
is sent over the control interface. This means that in case the ANQP
parsing fails there is no indication to the upper layers. Add an
ANQP-QUERY-DONE event that reports the status of the ANQP parsing.

Signed-off-by: ASHUTOSH NARAYAN <ashutoshx.narayan@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:26:21 +02:00
ASHUTOSH NARAYAN
d10b01d299 HS20: Provide appropriate permission to the OSU related files
The icon files and the osu-providers.txt that are generated may not have
proper permission for external programs to access. Set the access
permissions to the same as the permissions for osu_dir.

Signed-off-by: ASHUTOSH NARAYAN <ashutoshx.narayan@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:26:16 +02:00
Ilan Peer
dd09e424c2 Fix memory leak in wpa_supplicant global bgscan configuration
Global bgscan configuration parameter was not freed when config was
freed.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:10:05 +02:00
Eytan Lifshitz
30f459c098 wpa_cli: Fix NULL dereference on printf string argument
In wpa_cli_cmd_interface(), try_connection(), and main(), ctrl_ifname
may be NULL and could be dereferenced depending on the printf()
implementation.

Signed-off-by: Eytan Lifshitz <eytan.lifshitz@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:08:58 +02:00
Ilan Peer
b72b2ad39e P2P: Stop p2p_listen/find on wpas_p2p_invite
Stop any ongoing P2P listen/find flow before starting invitation flow.
This was partially handled in p2p_invite() that called p2p_find(), but
this did not cleanly handle cases such as long_listen.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
Ilan Peer
7e608d1def P2P: Use the correct wpa_s interface to handle P2P state flush
A control interface call to flush the current state used the
current wpa_s to clear the P2P state even though it might not
be the interface controlling the P2P state.

Fix it by using the correct interface to flush the P2P state.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
Eyal Shapira
fd83335f29 AP: Enable HT Tx STBC for AP/GO if supported by driver
Publish support for Tx STBC in the HT capabilities of a GO and AP
controlled by wpa_supplicant in case the hardware supports it.

Signed-off-by: Eyal Shapira <eyalx.shapira@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
Ben Rosenfeld
d90bfa97f4 Move external_scan_running to wpa_radio
external_scan_running should be common to all interfaces that share a
radio. This fixes a case where external_scan_running was set on a single
interface, but did not block scan on other interfaces.

Signed-off-by: Ben Rosenfeld <ben.rosenfeld@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
Ben
0c5f01fdf2 Clear reattach flag in fast associate flow
Clear the reattach flags, in case a connection request did not trigger a
scan. This needs to be done to avoid leaving the reattach flag set for
the next scan operation which may not have anything to do with the
specific request that could have been optimized using the single-channel
single-SSID scan.

Signed-off-by: Ben <ben.rosenfeld@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
David Spinadel
8ad8bc5c36 NFC: Redirect NFC commands on global control interface
Redirect NFC commands from global control interface to P2P device
interface.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
David Spinadel
57ae1f5be9 P2P: Fix P2P invitation with NFC
Use interface's own NFC configuration instead of parent's one
to support a P2P device dedicated interface.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2015-01-20 00:51:36 +02:00
Matti Gottlieb
07565ab0f9 WNM: Fix the length of WNM_BSS_QUERY control interface command
The length should be 14 and not 10.
The current situation causes failure during parsing of the command.

Signed-off-by: Matti Gottlieb <matti.gottlieb@intel.com>
2015-01-20 00:47:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2d9c99e37b Retry scan-for-connect if driver trigger fails
This restores some of the pre-radio work behavior for scanning by
retrying scan trigger if the driver rejects it (most likely returning
EBUSY in case of nl80211-drivers). Retry is indicated in the
CTRL-EVENT-SCAN-FAILED event with "retry=1".

For manual scans (e.g., triggered through "SCAN" control interface
command), no additional retries are performed. In other words, if upper
layers want to retry, they can do so based on the CTRL-EVENT-SCAN-FAILED
event.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-19 20:25:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
911942ee64 Add a test framework for various wpa_supplicant failure cases
For CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds, add a new test parameter than can
be used to trigger various error cases within wpa_supplicant operations
to make it easier to test error path processing. "SET test_failure
<val>" is used to set which operation fails. For now, 0 = no failures
and 1 = scan trigger fails with EBUSY. More operations can be added in
the future to extend coverage.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-19 19:34:00 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
95ff306988 nl80211: Allow HT/VHT to be disabled for IBSS
Allow HT/VHT overrides to be used for IBSS.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Masashi Honma
5a2a6de6a5 mesh: Make inactivity timer configurable
Current mesh code uses ap_max_inactivity as inactivity timer. This patch
makes it configurable.

There is another mesh inactivity timer in mac80211. The timer works even
if user_mpm=1. So this patch sets the max value to the timer for
workaround.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0efcad2c30 Print in debug log whether attached monitor is for global interface
It is easier to debug issues related to the wpa_supplicant control
interfaces being left behind in attached state when the debug log file
can be used to determine whether a specific monitor socket was a global
or per-interface one.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-18 16:23:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8266e6c6b4 HS 2.0: Try to use same BSS entry for storing GAS results
Commit 17b8995cf5 ('Interworking: Try to
use same BSS entry for storing GAS results') added a mechanism to try to
pair GAS request and response to a single BSS entry to cover cases where
multiple BSS entries may exists for the same BSSID. However, that commit
did not cover the Hotspot 2.0 ANQP elements. Extend this mechanism to
all ANQP elements. This can help in cases where information in the
Hotspot 2.0 specific ANQP elements got lost if a hidden SSID or some
other reason of duplicated BSS entries was present while doing ANQP
fetches.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-17 17:47:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6c69991382 Make wpa_supplicant FLUSH command more likely to clear all BSS entries
Move the wpa_bss_flush() call to the end of the function to allow any
pending user of a BSS entry to be cleared before removing the unused
entries. There were number of cases where BSS entries could have been
left in the list and this resulted in some hwsim test failures.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-17 15:39:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2dbe63ad53 Write reason for scan only_new_results into debug log
This can be helpful in figuring out why the driver was requested to
flush its scan results prior to starting a new scan.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-17 13:54:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
242b83a380 eapol_test: Fix cert_cb() function arguments
altsubject[] was added here, but the callback implementation in
eapol_test.c was forgotten from the commit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-17 02:24:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a8826b1848 Interworking: Avoid busy loop in scan result mismatch corner cases
It was possible for interworking_find_network_match() to find a possible
BSS match in a case where more thorough checks in
wpa_supplicant_select_bss() reject network. This itself is fine, in
general, but when combined with wpa_supplicant_fast_associate()
optimization and auto_interworking=1, this resulted in a busy loop of up
to five seconds and a possible stack overflow due to recursion in that
loop.

Fix this by limiting the Interworking wpa_supplicant_fast_associate()
call to be used only once per scan iteration, so that new scan
operations can be completed before going through the scan results again.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-17 01:52:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
edd5939a26 Interworking: Start ANQP fetch from eloop callback
Reduce maximum stack use by starting next ANQP fetch operation from an
eloop callback rather than calling interworking_next_anqp_fetch()
directly from interworking_start_fetch_anqp(). This avoids issues that
could potentially make the process run out of stack if long loops of
ANQP operations are executed in cases where automatic Interworking
network selection is used and scan results do not have a full match for
a network.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-17 01:51:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
783b2a977f Interworking: Fix INTERWORKING_CONNECT with zero-length SSID BSS entry
For Interworking connection to work, the SSID of the selected BSS needs
to be known to be able to associate with the AP. It was possible for the
scan results to include two BSS entries matching the BSSID when an
earlier scan with that AP has shown a hidden SSID configuration (e.g.,
when running hwsim test cases, but at least in theory, this could happen
with real use cases as well). When that happened, the incorrect BSS
entry may not have included RSN configuration and as such, it would get
rejected for Interworking connection.

Fix this by confirming that the selected BSS entry has a real SSID. If
not, try to find another BSS entry matching the same BSSID and use that,
if found with an SSID.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-15 12:24:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cebee30f31 Add domain_match network profile parameter
This is similar with domain_suffix_match, but required a full match of
the domain name rather than allowing suffix match (subdomains) or
wildcard certificates.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-14 15:45:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d07d3fbda2 Add peer certificate alt subject name information to EAP events
A new "CTRL-EVENT-EAP-PEER-ALT depth=<i> <alt name>" event is now used
to provide information about server certificate chain alternative
subject names for upper layers, e.g., to make it easier to configure
constraints on the server certificate. For example:
CTRL-EVENT-EAP-PEER-ALT depth=0 DNS:server.example.com

Currently, this includes DNS, EMAIL, and URI components from the
certificates. Similar information is priovided to D-Bus Certification
signal in the new altsubject argument which is a string array of these
items.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-14 15:45:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
98a4cd447e D-Bus: Clear cached EAP data on network profile changes
This makes D-Bus network profile Set(Properties) clear cached EAP data
similarly to how SET_NETWORK does for control interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-14 13:24:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
483dd6a5e0 Include peer certificate always in EAP events
This makes it easier for upper layer applications to get information
regarding the server certificate without having to use a special
certificate probing connection. This provides both the SHA256 hash of
the certificate (to be used with ca_cert="hash://server/sha256/<hash>",
if desired) and the full DER encoded X.509 certificate so that upper
layer applications can parse and display the certificate easily or
extract fields from it for purposes like configuring an altsubject_match
or domain_suffix_match.

The old behavior can be configured by adding cert_in_cb=0 to
wpa_supplicant configuration file.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-14 12:24:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d29fa3a767 Extend VENDOR_ELEM parameters to cover non-P2P Association Request
The new VENDOR_ELEM value 13 can now be used to add a vendor element
into all (Re)Association Request frames, not just for P2P use cases like
the previous item was for.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-14 01:12:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cf08e9b1f4 Add MESH to modes capabilities
This makes it easier for upper layer programs to figure out whether the
wpa_supplicant and and the driver supports mesh.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
db5adfe777 Add SAE to auth_alg capabilities
This makes it easier for upper layer programs to figure out whether the
wpa_supplicant and and the driver supports SAE.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a16514516b Add "GET tls_library" to provide information on TLS library and version
This new wpa_supplicant and hostapd control interface command can be
used to determine which TLS library is used in the build and what is the
version of that library.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b09baf37cf Work around Windows build issues
At least MinGW did not have ENOTCONN, EOPNOTSUPP, ECANCELED, so define
these to allow the build to go through.
wpas_rrm_send_neighbor_rep_request() is not really used on Windows, so
the exact error code values do not make any difference here.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:58:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0b402479bf Remove Network Security Service (NSS) support
NSS as a TLS/crypto library alternative was never completed and this
barely functional code does not even build with the current NSS version.
Taken into account that there has not been much interest in working on
this crypto wrapper over the years, it is better to just remove this
code rather than try to get it into somewhat more functional state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:58:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e24aef10cf Fix a typo in domain_suffix_match documentation
Spell SubjectName correctly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:27:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
394b54732e Improve subject_match and domain_suffix_match documentation
These were already covered in both README-HS20 for credentials and in
header files for developers' documentation, but the copy in
wpa_supplicant.conf did not include all the details. In addition, add a
clearer note pointing at subject_match not being suitable for suffix
matching domain names; domain_suffix_match must be used for that.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:27:01 +02:00
Stefan Tomanek
79cd993a62 Add address masks to BSSID lists
In many applications it is useful not just to enumerate a group of well
known access points, but to use a address/mask notation to match an
entire set of addresses (ca:ff:ee:00:00:00/ff:ff:ff:00:00:00).

This change expands the data structures used by MAC lists to include a
mask indicating the significant (non-masked) portions of an address and
extends the list parser to recognize mask suffixes.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Tomanek <stefan.tomanek@wertarbyte.de>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Stefan Tomanek
b83e455451 Add network specific BSSID black and white lists
This change adds the configuration options "bssid_whitelist" and
"bssid_blacklist" used to limit the AP selection of a network to a
specified (finite) set or discard certain APs.

This can be useful for environments where multiple networks operate
using the same SSID and roaming between those is not desired. It is also
useful to ignore a faulty or otherwise unwanted AP.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Tomanek <stefan.tomanek@wertarbyte.de>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Stefan Tomanek
b3d6a0a825 Add generic parser for MAC address lists
This change generalizes the code used for parsing the configuration
option 'p2p_client_list' and makes it suitable to use it in other
contexts.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Tomanek <stefan.tomanek@wertarbyte.de>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6dfc55723d Remove mesh_ht_mode network block parameter
There should not be a mesh-specific mechanism for setting up channel
parameters since that will just result in duplicated code. IBSS, mesh,
and AP mode can use the same data structures and parameters for setting
up such parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
54fe48b9dc mesh: Use the shared function with IBSS to determine channel parameters
Automatically enable HT20, HT40+, HT40-, or VHT, based on driver
capabilities. This obsoletes the mesh_ht_mode network block parameter
that was previously used to configure HT parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f7e889fa2d mesh: Convert channel configuration to use common routines
Use struct hostapd_freq_params just like other modes do instead of
mesh-specific freq and ht_mode.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6334330ed6 mesh: Use a separate variable to track whether HT is enabled
A network profile parameter should not be used to check whether the
currently operating mesh has HT enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
6b8b07741a ibss/mesh: Enable HT40 if supported
Setup HT40+/HT40- if supported by driver.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
269dfe232b Introduce common hw features
Introduce wpa_supplicant/hostapd hw features.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
1830817ece IBSS: Add WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_HT_IBSS
Add WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_HT_IBSS driver feature flag. Some drivers could not
set this feature and next could fail when we will enable HT support for
IBSS with error message: nl80211: Join IBSS failed: ret=-22 (Invalid
argument).

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Bob Copeland
a206e2a175 SAE: Centralize function for sending initial COMMIT
When performing SAE authentication in mesh, one station may
initiate authentication by sending a COMMIT as soon as a peer
candidate is discovered. Previously we did this in mesh_rsn.c,
but this left some of the state initialization in a different
part of the code from the rest of the state machine, and we may
need to add other initializations here in the future, so move
that to a more central function.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-01-10 11:43:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a354bcc886 D-Bus: Use NoMemory error message from CreateInterface
Try to be a bit more consistent by using NoMemory instead of InvalidArgs
if os_strdup() fails in the CreateInterface handler.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-09 02:32:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
635874b55a Handle interface disabled/enabled more consistently
It was possible for the interface not to be marked in INTERFACE_DISABLED
state in case the event was processed for P2P GO because the wpa_s
instance could have been removed in case of a separate group interface.
Change the state first to avoid leaving different state for the case
where separate group interface is not used.

Mark scan to be a normal scan on INTERFACE_ENABLED so that scanning
rules (e.g., skip scan if no networks enabled) get used consistently.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-08 22:43:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8f2cf37923 P2P: Indicate reason=UNAVAILABLE for group netdev going down
There is a race condition between receiving an AP stopped event and
netdev down event. These resulted in different group removal reasons on
a GO device (UNAVAILABLE for stop AP event coming first and REQUESTED
for netdev event first). Make this more consistent by reporting
UNAVAILABLE for both possible cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-08 22:43:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a156ffda61 Add support for testing memory allocation failures
The new control interface command TEST_ALLOC_FAIL and GET_ALLOC_FAIL can
now be used to trigger memory allocation failures for testing purposes.
TEST_ALLOC_FAIL sets a failure conditions with
<count>:func[;func][;func]... string and GET_ALLOC_FAIL returns the
current state using the same format. Whenever an allocation is made with
a matching backtrace of calling functions, the count is decremented by
one and once zero is reached, the allocation is forced to fail.

Function names can be prefixed with either '=' or '?' to get different
matching behavior. '=' requires this specific function to be the next
one in the backtrace (i.e., do not skip any other functions in the list
which is the default behavior). '?' allows the function to be optionally
present in the backtrace.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
52b3943c94 D-Bus: Fix interface unregistration on error path
It is possible for this function to get called even if D-Bus
registration had failed, so the path can be NULL here.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
96dc9a6d42 D-Bus (old): Fix interface unregistration on error path
It is possible for this function to be called even if D-Bus interface
registration has failed. Avoid a D-Bus assert in such a case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ef0355780a Fix memory leak on wpa_supplicant_init_wpa() error path
If wpa_sm_init() fails, the context data needs to be freed in the
caller.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f2d57282ad D-Bus: Fix string array dict entry parser in out-of-memory case
entry->strarray_value was left to point to freed memory in case
os_realloc_array() failed. This resulted in the following
wpa_dbus_dict_entry_clear() trying to free an already freed memory area.
In addition, the separately allocated strings in the array would have
been leaked in such a case. Furthermore, wpa_dbus_dict_entry_clear() was
not prepared for the possibility of the initial os_calloc() call failing
and entry->strarray_value being NULL without array_len being cleared to
zero. That would have resulted in reading uninitialized memory and NULL
pointer dereference.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c61bc23aa2 D-Bus: Fix byte array dict entry parser in out-of-memory case
entry->bytearray_value was left to point to freed memory in case
os_realloc_array() failed. This resulted in the following
wpa_dbus_dict_entry_clear() trying to free an already freed memory area.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dacf605812 D-Bus: Fix Introspect() in case of os_strdup() failure
add_interface() did not check for os_strdup() return value and could end
up dereferencing a NULL pointer if memory allocation failed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
68a866974b D-Bus (old): Fix wpsReg error message
This was supposed to return WpsRegError, not WpsPbcError.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f0614bc6c6 D-Bus (old): Fix message handler error paths
The error reply needs to be sent out as a response. The "out" label was
in incorrect place to allow that to happen; instead, it ended up leaking
memory for the generated reply message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a2af1c70c5 D-Bus (old): Fix memory leak on error path
If setSmartcardModules() fails to allocate memory with os_strdup(), the
allocated items in the dict entry were not freed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
942b75468d tests: Add module tests for AES-SIV
This moves the AES-SIV test case from tests/test-aes.c to be part of
wpa_supplicant module testing framework with a new
src/crypto/crypto_module_tests.c component. In addition, the second test
vector from RFC 5297 is also included for additional coverage.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 15:50:53 +02:00
Ilan Peer
8b48e32006 wpa_cli: Add MAC address randomization in scan
Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-04 23:06:31 +02:00
Ilan Peer
fb375883f4 ctrl_iface: Add MAC address randomization in scan processing
Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-04 23:06:31 +02:00
Ilan Peer
56c76fa592 scan: Add MAC address randomization in scan handling
1. Supported MAC address randomization for scan.
2. Supported MAC address randomization for scheduled scan.
2. Supported MAC address randomization for pno.
4. Add functions to set and clear the MAC address randomization
   state variables.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-04 23:06:31 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
7db53bb8c5 wpa_cli: Implement TDLS start/cancel channel switching commands
For the start operation, this includes appropriate parameters for
specifying channel and peer information. The cancel operation includes
peer information.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 21:46:37 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
6b90deae4d TDLS: Propagate enable/disable channel-switch commands to driver
The supplicant code does not try to control the actual channel of the
radio at any point. It simply passes the target peer and channel
parameters to the driver. It's the driver's responsibility to
periodically initiate TDLS channel-switch operations when TDLS
channel-switching is enabled.

Allow enable/disable operations to be invoked via the control interface.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 20:30:11 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
4daa572925 TDLS: Add channel-switch capability flag
Propagate a driver TDLS channel-switch support bit from nl80211 to
TDLS code.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:59:31 +02:00
Eliad Peller
8c42b36902 WMM AC: Reconfigure tspecs on reassociation to the same BSS
The specification requires the tspecs to be kept upon reassociation to
the same BSS. Save the last tspecs before such reassociation, and
reconfigure on the association notification.

Note that the current flow is not transparent to the user
(it is notified about deauth/reassoc and tspec removal/addition).

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:41:00 +02:00
Eliad Peller
677e7a9582 WMM AC: Do not fail on unknown IEs in Association Response
Some APs add their custom (vendor-specific) IEs to the Association
Response frame. Fail WMM AC initialization only if Association Response
frame IE parsing actually failed, i.e., ignore all unknown IEs.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:33:29 +02:00
Eliad Peller
fecc2bb5a8 WMM AC: Delete tspecs on roaming
In case of roaming, we don't get disassoc notification, but
still want to remove the existing tspecs.

Move the wmm_ac_notify_disassoc() call to the state change
function, which get called also on roaming.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:32:59 +02:00
Eliad Peller
20fe74561c WMM AC: Print user-priority in wmm_ac_status
The UP is important property of the tspec, so print it as well.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:31:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d118a6b8c8 D-Bus: Fix WPS.Start method in AP/P2P GO mode
Previously, role="enrollee" was required to be used to allow the AP mode
WPS operation to be started. This is incorrect since the AP/GO will
operate in Registrar role. Fix this by ignoring the role parameter when
AP (including P2P GO) mode is enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bd47d68035 WPS: Reject station-mode WPS operations when AP mode is enabled
Start of station-mode WPS PBC/PIN/Registrar/NFC operation would result
in the AP mode getting disabled. This can be particularly confusing for
the P2P GO case where the group would need to be stopped cleanly. As
such, it is better to reject these invalid operations rather than trying
to handle all corner cases needed to allow this to work robustly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f47a562c73 D-Bus: Move NetworkRequest signal to correct registration array
This is an interface signal, not a global signal, so move it to the
current array for registering the signal.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
afaa6d99a4 D-Bus: Remove registration of P2PStateChanged signal
This signal is not generated anywhere, so there is no point in claiming
it to be available.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1a4efde5bd D-Bus: Make P2P Group Passphrase property getter available for P2P Client
There is no need to limit this property based on the role of the device
in the group, so return the passphrase if it is available. It will be
available in GO role and it may be available in P2P Client role based on
whether the peer GO provided it during the WPS provisioning step.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
20e1d81e09 D-Bus: Fix P2P Group PSK property getter
This was returning a byte array of the pointer to the PSK, not the
actual PSK, due to incorrect use of
wpas_dbus_simple_array_property_getter(). In addition, there is no need
to limit this property based on the role of the device in the group, so
return the PSK if it is available (which it will be for both GO and P2P
Client roles).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a0caebf397 D-Bus: Simplify out-of-memory reporting
There is no need to have separate wpa_printf() and different error
message strings for the unlikely out-of-error messages. Use a helper
function, wpas_dbus_error_no_memory(), to get consistent behavior with a
one-line call.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff1d8104e2 D-Bus: Remove the obsolete notes from wpas_dbus_error_unknown_error()
Commit 6aeeb6fa21 ('dbus: clean up new
D-Bus interface getters and setters') redesigned the property
getter/setter calls in a way that made the
wpas_dbus_error_unknown_error() note about message being NULL in some
cases obsolete. All the remaining callers are from method handler
functions that must have a valid message. Remove the obsolete notes and
unnecessary messsage == NULL check.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
38279bdb35 D-Bus: Coding style cleanup
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e3c4f0b5d5 D-Bus: Simplify message building error paths
There is no need to have multiple separate return statements for error
cases in a sequence of operations. In addition, there is not much point
in "converting" boolean return values with "if (!res) return FALSE;
return TRUE;" style constructions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bba40b65b0 D-Bus: Fix GroupAdd, Invite, RemovePersistentGroup path validation
net_id_str can be NULL and that must be checked for to avoid NULL
pointer dereference if an invalid persistent_group_object path is used
with these methods.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ce82168b55 D-Bus: Fix error message for Listen() failure
DBUS_ERROR_NO_MEMORY does not look like the best option for the failure
reason in case wpas_p2p_listen() fails.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
054dc3136f D-Bus: Clean up wpas_dbus_new_decompose_object_path()
None of the new D-Bus interface cases use the bssid_part in
decompose_object_path (while the old interface ones do). As such, this
is dead code and can be removed. In addition, the P2P addition here was
pretty ugly extension. Replace these with a cleaner way of passing the
separating string (e.g., "Networks") from the caller and returning the
requested item.

In addition, there is no need to allocate the returned item separately,
so use a single allocation and a pointer to that allocated memory. This
will make it easier for callers to have to free only a single
allocation. This is also fixing a memory leak in P2P invitation
persistent group case where the caller had missed the need to free the
returned values.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b76ea413b1 D-Bus: Clean up parse_peer_object_path() uses
This helper function does not modify peer_path, so mark it const. In
addition, there is no point in callers to check separately whether
peer_path is NULL since that is taken care of by this helper function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
509618d35b D-Bus: Remove useless NULL check from static function
The entry argument cannot be NULL in this static function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d12c08847 D-Bus: Add debug prints for parsing dict entries
This makes it easier to figure out what happens if there are issues with
processing messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
605325fb75 D-Bus: Remove useless wpa_s->conf checks
This cannot be NULL when an interface is in use. There is not much point
in couple of functions checking this while large number of other places
do not.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
88ce7938b0 D-Bus: Write Get/Set property name in debug log
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5485798f40 D-Bus: Add more debug prints to cover operations
This adds the message signature to the new D-Bus interface message
handler and similar prints to the old interface messages handlers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7fbe56b018 D-Bus: Fix property change timer update
eloop_is_timeout_registered() was called with incorrect context argument
which meant that the pending timeout would have never been found.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3a593ff5b2 D-Bus (old): Fix removeNetwork method to not use freed memory
wpa_supplicant_deauthenticate() call needs to happen before
wpa_config_remove_network(). Freed memory could be dereferenced if
removeNetwork method was issued on the currently connected network.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f11e797d4c D-Bus: Avoid valgrind warning due to compiler optimization
It looks like both gcc and clang optimize the (entry.type != foo ||
entry.array_type != bar) in a way that ends up evaluating the second
condition even when the first one results in 0. While this is not really
what the C language requirements on short-circuit evaluation require,
the compiler likely assumes this can have no side effects and with both
type and array_type being comparable in a single 64-bit operation, this
can clearly be a bit more efficient. While the code behaves same in both
cases, valgrind does warn about use of uninitialized memory when the
second condition is evaluated (entry.array_type is not initialized if
entry.type != DBUS_TYPE_ARRAY).

To keep valgrind logs cleaner, initialize entry.array_type to
DBUS_TYPE_INVALID so that these compiler optimizations do not result in
reading uninitialized memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:50:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
19d4dab759 D-Bus: Avoid compiler warning on sometimes uninitialized variable
The logic in wpas_dbus_signal_p2p_provision_discovery() seemed to imply
that there could be a case where _signal would be used uninitized. While
that is not the case since either (request || !status) or (!request &&
status) would always be true, some compilers do not seem to be clever
enough to figure that out to avoid the warning. Make this easier for
such compilers by removing the (!request && status) condition since it
is identical to !(request || !status).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:48:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bc7baaff24 D-Bus: Make WPAS_DBUS_TYPE_BINARRAY value less confusing
Commit 911e97e400 ('DBus: Refactor array
adding, add binary arrays') introduced WPAS_DBUS_TYPE_BINARRAY as an
internal fake type for array_type. However, it selected this value to be
(DBUS_NUMBER_OF_TYPES + 100) = 116 = 't'. This happens to conflict with
DBUS_TYPE_UINT64 ((int) 't'). While none of the existing array_type use
cases supported UINT64, it is much clearer if WPAS_DBUS_TYPE_BINARRAY
has a value that does not match any existing DBUS_TYPE_* value. Replace
this with '@' (64).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-01 13:51:45 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5f3682dc6f D-Bus: Fix dict binarray getter to accept empty array of array
This is needed to allow Set(P2PDeviceConfig) to clear the
VendorExtension array (i.e., to remove all configured vendor
extensions). Previously, such an attempt was met with a D-Bus assert and
rejection of the operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-31 13:34:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
54e06b4ffb D-Bus: Fix memory leak on P2PDeviceConfig::VendorExtension
The wps_vendor_ext array can be set using D-Bus Set(P2PDeviceConfig)
with the VendorExtension key in the dictionary. However, there was no
code for freeing the allocated memory when the interface is removed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-31 13:07:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
68bb007743 D-Bus: Fix GONegotiationSuccess signal passphrase format
Passphrase is a variable length string of (8..63 characters), not a byte
array of fixed 64 octets.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-31 11:44:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3cccf0b870 D-Bus: Make wpas_dbus_error_scan_error() static
This function is not used anywhere outside this file.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-31 11:00:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2544394406 D-Bus: Fix ServiceDiscoveryResponse to accept int32 dialog_token
The ServiceDiscoveryRequest signal uses int32 for encoding dialog_token
for some reason (even though this is a u8 field).
ServiceDiscoveryResponse is supposed to accept the values from the
signal as-is, so extend that to accept int32 in addition to the
previously used uint32.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-31 10:47:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9c4694ce7c D-Bus: Fix memory leaks on AddService/DeleteService error paths
The query and service parameters need to be freed on all paths to avoid
memory leaks in error cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-31 01:05:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b07f1ebe0f D-Bus: Fix .Group Set(WPSVendorExtensions) format
The earlier implementation seemed to require a strange extra
encapsulation with a dictionary for setting the WPSVendorExtensions
property while this was defined to have aay signature and the get
operation did indeed return and array of array of bytes without that
dictionary. Fix this to accept aay format for the setter as well. Keep
support for the old dictionary encapsulation format for backwards
compatibility.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-30 22:22:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8509fb5cce D-Bus: Fix memory leak on P2P GO WPSVendorExtensions
It was possible to add WPS vendor extensions through the D-Bus
WPSVendorExtensions setter, but these extensions were not freed when the
P2P GO was stopped or when replacing previously configured extensions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-30 22:22:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4e70bbf1c6 SAE: Clear keys from memory on disassociation
There is no need to keep temporary keys in memory beyond the end of the
association, so explicitly clear any SAE buffers that can contain keys
as soon as such keys are not needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 20:00:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6df1973988 Clear psk_list while freeing config_ssid instances
Previously, the main PSK entry was cleared explicitly, but psk_list
could include PSKs for some P2P use cases, so clear it as well when
freeing config_ssid instances.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e886c88e95 Explicitly clear the temporary stack-based PSK buffer
There is no need to leave this temporary key in stack memory after
having been configured to the WPA state machine.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
658da804e5 Explicitly clear the temporary stack-based key for WPA-None
There is no need to leave this temporary key in stack memory after
having been configured to the driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f42df14415 WPS ER: Explicitly clear PSK from stack after use
There is no need to leave the PSK from temporary Credential structure
that was built in stack after that Credential has been passed to the WPS
module.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ce52d031e5 Clear wpa_psk memory when setting up wpa_supplicant AP mode
This is more of a theoretical case since this part is done only during
setup and the structure is not allocated in practice. Anyway,
maintaining more consistent use of bin_clear_free() for structures that
may contain keys is useful.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
74df9c1c43 D-Bus(old): Remove duplicated blob->data check
This was already verified to be non-NULL above and there is no point in
having an extra check after the pointer has already been dereferenced.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8193e01e5b D-Bus(old): Remove unnecessary wpa_supplicant_state_txt() check
This function cannot return NULL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
62856ad989 D-Bus(old): Fix removeNetwork and selectNetwork error handling
wpas_dbus_decompose_object_path() may leave the network part NULL on
unexpected path. This resulted in NULL pointer dereference when
processing an invalid removeNetwork or selectNetwork call. Fix this by
explicitly verifying that the network part was included in the object
path.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
84edd136b5 D-Bus(old): Fix interface to show correct err_msg for blob removal
The "Invalid blob name" string was not shown since the zero-length name
was used regardless of first verifying that it should not be allowed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
91c539c01d D-Bus(old): Fix WPS interface to require BSSID for wpsReg
External WPS Registrar operation requires the BSSID to be specified, so
the old D-Bus interface better apply that requirement as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dddd870d16 D-Bus(old): Fix WPS interface for PIN from wpa_supplicant case
dbus_message_append_args() needs char** and &npin ended up being char*
and resulted in segmentation fault.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5f136bc126 D-Bus: Fix P2P persistent group removal from non-D-Bus triggers
It is possible for the persistent group object to be added and removed
by non-D-Bus triggers (e.g., ctrl_iface commands). The add part was
already handled, but removal was not. That resulted in memory leaks when
a P2P persistent group was removed without using an explicit D-Bus
command for this even if the object was added without D-Bus involvement.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d20be3a739 D-Bus: Fix WPS ConfigMethods getter to handle no value properly
wpas_dbus_simple_property_getter() cannot be used with NULL
DBUS_TYPE_STRING, so replace that with an empty string to handle the
case of no config_methods parameter in the configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
11973b2682 D-Bus: Fix P2P peer joined/disconnected handlers
It is possible for the peer to be a non-P2P device and as such, for
p2p_dev_addr to be NULL. This resulted in NULL pointer dereference if
D-Bus interface was enabled for the interface when a legacy STA joined a
group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b8db1dfc5c Clear next_scan_freqs on wpa_supplicant FLUSH command
It was possible for old scan state to remain from a previous test case
when an operation like WNM neighbor scan or another-BSS-in-ESS was
started, but stopped at the end of a test case. This could result in
failures, e.g., when running wnm_bss_tm_req followed by scan_setband.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f4637fe0fd wpa_supplicant: Set stdout line-buffered
This makes wpa_supplicant debug output in stdout line-buffered to remain
consistent with hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
010fa245bd Add QUIET=1 option for make
This can be used to reduce verbosity for build messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
49e3eea8d9 Avoid -Wshadow warnings from older gcc versions
It looks like gcc 4.8.2 would warn about these with -Wshadow, but 4.6.3
did.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-26 13:21:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a193231dfb Clean up debug prints to use wpa_printf()
This converts most of the remaining perror() and printf() calls from
hostapd and wpa_supplicant to use wpa_printf().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-26 13:20:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
36f0cf3774 privsep: Fix compilation due to associate() parameter updates
struct wpa_driver_associate_params moved to using struct
hostapd_freq_params instead of just frequency. Need to update wpa_priv
to do same.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4a393fe9f8 WPS: Do not indicate PBC overlap for the same BSS
Even if the UUID would have a mismatch, e.g., due to no UUID known for
the target in a new WPS PBC instance, do not indicate PBC session
overlap if the BSSID is same in the two entries. This should not really
happen in normal use cases, but can happen at least in some test
scenarios where the same BSSID is used in consecutive test cases and the
old BSS entry remains in cfg80211 cache.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3a322496f9 mesh: Delay Authentication frame process with no_auto_peer
There is a possible race condition between receiving the
NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE event and the Authentication frame from the peer.
Previously, if the Authentication frame RX event was indicated first,
that frame got dropped silently. Now, this frame is still dropped, but a
copy of it is stored and the frame gets processed on the following
NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE event if that is received for the same peer within
two seconds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-23 13:44:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d97a3c4885 SME: Optimize OBSS scanning
Include only the potentially affected channel range in OBSS scans to
reduce the amount of offchannel time needed for scanning when requested
by the AP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-22 22:07:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
267ac3bcd6 Add more debug prints for WPA/RSN selection issues for connection
ap_ft_sae test case managed to hit a somewhat unclear error case which
resulted in "WPA: Failed to select WPA/RSN" print and not enough
information to figure out what exactly had went wrong.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-22 13:49:52 +02:00
Masashi Honma
d5b95325de mesh: Fill Number of Peerings field in Mesh Formation Info
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:59:40 +02:00
Masashi Honma
46e8d90f6a mesh: Add debug message when peering limit is reached
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:55:44 +02:00
Masashi Honma
4b4093686b mesh: Make maximum number of peer links configurable
Maximum number of peer links is maximum number of connecting mesh peers
at the same time. This value is 0..255 based on the
dot11MeshNumberOfPeerings range.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:52:31 +02:00
Masashi Honma
9c58c5f72c mesh: Make beacon interval configurable
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:38:20 +02:00
Masashi Honma
3b797130d7 doc: Remove error on document creation
Unexpected trailing zero causes following error.

wpa_supplicant.sgml:472:53:E: character data is not allowed here

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:36:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
422ba11e30 Flush WPS registrar state on wpa_supplicant FLUSH command
This helps hwsim test cases by avoiding undesired state from previously
executed test cases affecting following tests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-21 17:47:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
209702d4c9 Add possibility to set the setband parameter
Commit faf9a8585d added mechanism for
selecting 2.4 or 5 GHz band for scan operation. However, no mechanism
for setting the setband value was added at that time. This commit adds a
new SET ctrl_iface parameter to allow the setband functionality to be
used. "SET setband <AUTO/5G/2G>" can be used to select all bands, 5 GHz
band only, or 2.4 GHz band only.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-19 22:56:41 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
ee82e33d6a Do not trigger the scan during initialization on Android platforms
Android framework maintains a state to process the scan results after
the scan is issued. If wpa_supplicant issues the scan during the
initialization, the one issued by the framework may fail (with EBUSY) if
the host driver is already processing the scan. Thus, the scan results
returned for the first scan triggered by wpa_supplicant are not
processed for getting displayed resulting in delay for the display of
the first scan results after the Wi-Fi subsystem initialization. Thus,
trigger the scan only based on the framework request on Android.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-19 15:24:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e69ae5ff31 Reject new SCAN commands if there is a pending request
FAIL-BUSY was already returned for the case where a scan had been
started, but with the radio work design, it would have been possible to
schedule multiple scan requests if a non-scan radio work was in
progress. Multiple back-to-back scans are not usually very helpful, so
reject this type of cases where the SCAN command would be used to build
such a sequence.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-19 15:14:38 +02:00
Jithu Jance
49e1e9ca88 P2P: Avoid truncation of long listen operation due to offchan tx
On receiving the cancel remain on channel event, the pending_tx
is scheduled immediately and returned. This was preventing
the wpas_p2p_listen_start function from execution thereby resulting
in termination of the long listen operation.

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2014-12-18 16:41:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0855e2e188 Do not allow network block scan_freq override SCAN command frequencies
The manual scan operations with the SCAN command are supposed to have
independent set of scan frequencies, so do not allow scan_freq
parameters to override scanned frequencies for scans that were triggered
with a SCAN command.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-15 00:55:56 +02:00
Masashi Honma
5b78493f3b mesh: Add mesh interface creation command for mesh gate
The mesh gate is used to bridge (or route) between mesh network and
another network. For example, mesh gate acts as router between mesh
network and IEEE 802.11 BSS network.

This command makes a virtual mesh interface to be used for mesh gate.

This command expects to be used like this.

wpa_cli -i wlan0 MESH_INTERFACE_ADD ifname=mesh0
wpa_cli -i mesh0 add_network
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 ssid '"commell_2X_mmm"'
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 mode 5
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 frequency 2412
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 key_mgmt SAE
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 psk '"01234567"'
wpa_cli -i mesh0 mesh_group_add 0
wpa_cli -i wlan0 mesh_group_remove mesh0

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-14 23:27:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e77007132e Extend wpa_supplicant STA* ctrl_iface commands for mesh
Since mesh functionality uses struct hostapd_data to maintain peer
state, the existing STA* control interface commands can be used to
display information about the peers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 20:14:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b0f33467a5 Clean up VHT override max A-MPDU override calculation
There is no need to use runtime call to find_first_bit() to determine
shift amount for a constant integer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 18:48:59 +02:00
Led
2797486c4f Fix bashisms in wps-ap-cli script
Option '-p' of 'read' command may be unsupported in some POSIX-complete
shells. So replace 'read -p' with 'echo -n'/'read' pair.

Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Chumachenko <ledest@gmail.com>
2014-12-14 18:27:54 +02:00
Arkadiusz (Arkq) Bokowy
7b244d577a wpa_gui: Quiet mode - disable tray icon messages
If tray icon messages are perceived as disturbing, one can pass `-q`
parameter on the command line to disable them permanently.

Signed-off-by: Arkadiusz Bokowy <arkadiusz.bokowy@gmail.com>
2014-12-14 17:26:42 +02:00
Arkadiusz (Arkq) Bokowy
2087b64fef wpa_gui: More informative tray icon tool tip message
Show associated network SSID in the tool tip message of the
application's tray icon. When network is not associated, then simple
"(not-associated)" message is shown.

Signed-off-by: Arkadiusz Bokowy <arkadiusz.bokowy@gmail.com>
2014-12-14 17:23:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
81648d0041 SAE: Report connection failure if SME cannot build auth frame
Instead of just stopping connection process and network discovery,
report SAE failures to build Authentication frames (e.g., due to missing
password) as a connection failure to get the normal retry mechanism into
use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 16:48:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8e3afd7f6c offchannel: Use wpas_get_tx_interface() src parameter more consistently
Both the wpa_s->pending_action_src and src argument to
wpas_get_tx_interface() were used somewhat randomly. Make this more
consistent since these values are pointing to the same address and the
implementation is easier to understand when it is obvious that there is
only one address being used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 15:47:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
568475b70b HS 2.0: Allow CANCEL_FETCH_OSU to stop at scan completion
There is no need to start the GAS/ANQP fetch if the FETCH_OSU operation
has already been canceled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 02:28:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f77cedc11a WPS ER: Remove unnecessary return value
wps_er_deinit() cannot fail and it does not return anything, so neither
should wpas_wps_er_stop().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 02:28:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5407c69d15 Remove unnecessary STA_AUTOCONNECT handler function
This function could not fail and it can be replaced with a single
line variable update that takes less code than the function call.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-13 19:27:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a1144000cd Remove unnecessary return value
wpa_bss_flush*() cannot fail and as such, there is no need for
wpa_supplicant_ctrl_iface_bss_flush() to return a value either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-13 19:22:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5ac73acf12 Simplify eapol_sm_get_mib() result handling
This function cannot return negative value, so no need to check for
that. If there is not enough room in the buffer or if something
unexpected happens, 0 is returned.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-13 19:15:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
43a66ecba3 Fix SCAN control interface command error cases
Update the scan parameters in wpa_s only in case the scan command is
going to be executed. In other words, do not change the parameters for
an ongoing scan (the SCAN command is rejected with FAIL-BUSY) or if any
of the parameters is invalid.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-12 01:12:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2961bfa8e1 Remove unused send_eapol() driver op
The send_eapol() callback was used by driver_test.c, but with that
removed, there is no remaining users of the alternative EAPOL frame
transmitting mechanism in wpa_supplicant, i.e., all remaining driver
interfaces use l2_packet instead. Remove the send_eapol() to get rid of
unused code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-11 15:40:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b68d602dc4 Fix ANQP_GET/HS20_GET_ANQP parsing to skip space after address
The space following the BSSID was not skipped properly if the following
parameter started with the "hs20:" prefix. For other cases, atoi() ended
up ignoring the space, but it is cleaner to skip it anyway for all
cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-11 15:18:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
42a697256e P2P: Allow cross connection on the parent interface
Previously, any P2P capable interface was skipped in cross connection
uplink consideration. However, this ends up skipping more or less all
nl80211-based driver cases now since they mark the main interface P2P
capable. Relax this rule to allow the parent interface to be used as the
non-P2P station interface for cross connection purposes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-10 01:54:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
97cfe110dc Clear wpa_s->disconnected on ctrl_iface FLUSH
This is needed to get into more consistent state after the FLUSH
command. DISCONNECT followed by FLUSH could result in
wpa_s->disconnected being left to 1 and this resulted in a test failure,
e.g., when running wpas_ctrl_dup_network followed by
wpas_ctrl_enable_disable_network where the latter was expecting
ENABLE_NETWORK on a disabled network to connect automatically and that
does not happen if wpa_s->disconnected == 1.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-08 16:22:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aaadd72733 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - more checks
Add more os_snprintf() result validation checks.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d39977136 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently
While these are using practically large enoungh buffer sizes, it is
better to be more consistent with checking os_snprintf() return value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1f102d3bb0 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - manual
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() for cases that were note covered by spatch and
semantic patches.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
eeab4f2fda Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - automatic 3
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() where the comparison was 'res > size' instead of
'res >= size - 1'. These changes were done automatically with spatch
using the following semantic patch:

@@
identifier E1;
expression E2,E3,E4,E5,E6;
statement S1;
@@

(
  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  int E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else if (E6)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = 0;
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else if (E6) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  }
)
? os_free(E4);
- if (E1 < 0 || (size_t) E1 >= E3 - 1)
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7bdd8981f7 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - automatic 2
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() where the comparison was 'res > size' instead of
'res >= size'. These changes were done automatically with spatch using
the following semantic patch:

@@
identifier E1;
expression E2,E3,E4,E5,E6;
statement S1;
@@

(
  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  int E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else if (E6)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = 0;
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else if (E6) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  }
)
? os_free(E4);
- if (E1 < 0 || \( E1 > E3 \| (size_t) E1 > E3 \| E1 > (int) E3 \))
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d85e1fc8a5 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - automatic 1
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() where the exact rule used in os_snprintf_error() was
used. These changes were done automatically with spatch using the
following semantic patch:

@@
identifier E1;
expression E2,E3,E4,E5,E6;
statement S1;
@@

(
  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  int E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else if (E6)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = 0;
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else if (E6) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  }
)
? os_free(E4);
- if (E1 < 0 || \( E1 >= E3 \| (size_t) E1 >= E3 \| (unsigned int) E1 >= E3 \| E1 >= (int) E3 \))
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a80ba67a26 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - success case
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() in cases where success condition was used to execute
a step. These changes were done automatically with spatch using the
following semantic patch:

@@
expression E1,E2,E3;
statement S1;
@@

  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
- if (\( E1 >= 0 \| E1 > 0 \) && \( (size_t) E1 < E3 \| E1 < (int) E3 \| E1 < E3 \))
+ if (!os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
  S1

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a9aaacbb50 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - maximum length
This adds verification of os_snprintf() result against the maximum
buffer length. These changes were done automatically with spatch
using the following semantic patch:

@@
expression E1,E2,E3;
statement S1;
@@

  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
- if (\( E1 < 0 \| E1 <= 0 \))
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
faebdeaa9e Use os_calloc() instead of os_zalloc()
Automatic changes with spatch using the following semantic patch:

@@
constant C;
type T;
@@

- os_zalloc(C*sizeof(T))
+ os_calloc(C,sizeof(T))

@@
expression E;
type T;
@@

- os_zalloc((E)*sizeof(T))
+ os_calloc(E,sizeof(T))

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c054190603 Fix DUP_NETWORK debug print on error case
Incorrect network id was printed in debug output if DUP_NETWORK
destination network was not found.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
49328f0756 Remove unnecessary ctrl_iface command check
MESH_GROUP_REMOVE always passes in the cmd pointer, so this cannot
really be NULL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d02dcb28bc Remove unnecessary ctrl_iface cmd check
This pointer cannot be NULL sicne it is called only from this file and
with a valid pointer to the received command.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:07:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d84416a2af Interworking: Make bounds checking easier for static analyzers
'num * 5 > end - pos' handles bounds checking a bit more efficiently,
but apparently that is not clear enough for all static analyzers.
Replace with 'num > left / 5' to avoid false reports. (CID 68117)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 19:25:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8105821b39 Replace send_ft_action() driver_op with send_action()
This reduced number of unnecessarily duplicated driver interface
callback functions for sending Action frames by using the more generic
send_action() instead of FT specific send_ft_action().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 18:13:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bc0ba01d70 WFD: Allow WFD_SUBELEM_SET/GET all to be used with full IE buffer
This extends the previously used WFD_SUBELEM_SET/GET <subelem id> design
to allow special "all" value to be used as an id to indicate that all
WFD subelements are to be set/get. This uses similar interface as was
previously added over D-Bus.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-05 15:22:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f80936094e WMM-AC: Use DEBUG verbosity for ignoring Action frame messages
There is no point in flooding the log with WARNING or ERROR level
messages if WMM-AC related Action frames are ignored in cases where they
were not expected. In addition, WARNING/ERROR should not really be used
in cases an invalid frame is dropped especially if this is not related
to a security setup since external devices could otherwise generate log
entries.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-05 13:17:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0570a3ea7d HS 2.0: Clarify OSU Provider list length validation
The previous version was somewhat too complex for some static analyzers.
Use local variables for the extracted length fields and explicitly
compare these against the remaining buffer length. (CID 68121)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-05 00:56:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
65d9a5e254 ERP: Add wpa_supplicant ERP_FLUSH ctrl_iface command
This can be used to flush all the ERP keys.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:16:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
02a8d45ace ERP: Add support for ERP on EAP peer
Derive rRK and rIK on EAP peer if ERP is enabled. The new wpa_supplicant
network configuration parameter erp=1 can now be used to configure the
EAP peer to derive EMSK, rRK, and rIK at the successful completion of an
EAP authentication method. This functionality is not included in the
default build and can be enabled with CONFIG_ERP=y.

If EAP authenticator indicates support for re-authentication protocol,
initiate this with EAP-Initiate/Re-auth and complete protocol when
receiving EAP-Finish/Re-auth.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:16:29 +02:00
Dmitry Shmidt
f34891a3af Return only full network line in list_networks
It makes more sense to truncate at line boundary especially with the new
LAST_ID parameter.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2014-12-03 22:31:53 +02:00
Vinit Deshpande
90903a77ef List all networks despite message limit of 4096 bytes
This change creates 'LIST_NETWORK LAST_ID=x' form to allow
retrieval of all networks saved in the system. Without this form,
only first few (whatever fills in first 4096 bytes) can be
retrieved.

Signed-off-by: Vinit Deshpande <vinitd@google.com>
2014-12-02 23:47:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
44177b69e8 Allow a BSS entry with all-zeros BSSID to expire
wpa_bss_in_use() used to determine that a BSS with BSSID of
00:00:00:00:00:00 is in use in almost every case since either
wpa_s->bssid or wpa_s->pending_bssid was likely to be cleared. This
could result in a corner case of a BSS entry remaining in the BSS table
indefinitely if one was added there with a (likely bogus) address of
00:00:00:00:00:00. Fix this by ignore wpa_s->bssid and
wpa_s->pending_bssid if the BSSID in the BSS table entry is
00:00:00:00:00:00.

In theory, that address is a valid BSSID, but it is unlikely to be used
in any production AP, so the potential expiration of a BSS entry with
that address during a connection attempt would not be a concern
(especially when a new scan would be enough to recover from that).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-02 19:46:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e374522827 Do not start new radio work on scan completion during ext work
Externally triggered scan could result in a new radio work item getting
started even when external radio work was in progress. Delay such start
until the external work is completed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-01 20:17:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4f9a5ea5cc WPS: Fix current_ssid clearing on duplicate network removal
It was possible for the current network profile to be deleted when
merging duplicated WPS credentials. However, this did not clear
wpa_s->current_ssid and it was possible for something else to end up
dereferencing that pointer to now freed memory. This could be hit, e.g.,
with ap_wps_mixed_cred. Fix this by clearing current_ssid also in this
code path similarly to other cases of network block getting removed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e4a35f07d9 mesh: Skip fast-association when using connect_without_scan
The mesh group addition was designed to use wpa_s->connect_without_scan
to skip a scan. That path was skipped if wpa_supplicant_fast_associate()
allowed previous scan results to be used. This could result in undesired
double-initialization attempt for the mesh interface. Avoid this by not
using wpa_supplicant_fast_associate() when wpa_s->connect_without_scan
is set.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
608b0ff52a mesh: Check for initialization failures
It is possible that these location ended up getting called before mesh
startup operations had been completed and that could result in
dereferencing NULL pointers. Address those error cases by verifying that
the needed parameters are available before using them.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9a700ff9ef Ignore auth/assoc timeout events in mesh configuration
It was possible for auth/assoc timeout/failure event from the driver to
result in unexpected processing during mesh group setup if that
operation was started before the previously started driver operation to
association/connect had completed. Since those events cannot happen in
mesh cases, ignore them to avoid issues due to this corner case.

For example, monitor_iface_unknown_sta followed by wpas_mesh_secure test
case resulted in failure without this change.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
763041b2e8 mesh: Avoid a false maybe-uninitialized compiler warning
An earlier check of the action_field value above the switch statement
already took care of all other possible cases, but that was apparently
too difficult for the compiler to notice. Bring back the default case to
avoid incorrect warnings about the event variable being maybe
uninitialized.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c932b43e56 mesh: Add more debug information to MPM Action frame processing
This makes it easier to figure out why a peering message is dropped.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 23:02:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fc0ef7c0e7 Add DATA_TEST_FRAME for testing Data frame processing
The new wpa_supplicant control interface command can be used in
automated testing to verify how AP processes Data frames with arbitrary
contents. This is enabled only in builds with CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 23:51:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b925506a91 Clear RSN preauth and PMKSA cache state on FLUSH command
There is no need for this state to maintained when the wpa_supplicant
FLUSH ctrl_iface command is used to request flushing of all state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 19:56:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3882a70841 WMM AC: Fix memory leak on deinit without disassoc event
It was possible for wmm_ac_deinit() not getting called when an interface
was removed in a sequence where disassociation was not reported and
wmm_ac_notify_disassoc() did not get called. This resulted in leaking
whatever memory was allocated for WMM AC parameters. Fix that by calling
wmm_ac_notify_disassoc() from wpa_supplicant_cleanup().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 19:00:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5214f4fafc Clear scan_req to NORMAL_SCAN_REQ for connection attempt
This is needed to fix some sequencies where a real scan in ap_scan=2
case would be issued even when the connection case would expect direct
connection without a scan.

This fixed an issue shown in hwsim test case autoscan_exponential
followed by ibss_open_fixed_bssid.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 17:55:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4e0990dc88 mesh: Send peering close message before leaving mesh
This is needed to allow proper Action frame transmission to work without
having to claim these to be offchannel operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 17:12:47 +02:00
Neelansh Mittal
3a7414b6a6 Do not re-open Android control sockets
On Android, the control socket being used may be the socket that is
created when wpa_supplicant is started as a /init.*.rc service. Such a
socket is maintained as a key-value pair in Android's environment.
Closing this control socket would leave wpa_supplicant in a bad state.
When wpa_supplicant re-opens the ctrl_iface socket, it will query the
Android's environment, and will be returned with the same socket
descriptor that has already been closed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-25 17:16:44 +02:00
Masashi Honma
a959a3b69d SAE: Fix Anti-Clogging Token request frame format
This commit inserts Finite Cyclic Group to Anti-Clogging Token request
frame because IEEE Std 802.11-2012, Table 8-29 says "Finite Cyclic Group
is present if Status is zero or 76".

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-11-25 16:08:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
849367afe9 SME: Fix a sign-compare warning
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-25 01:07:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
158211b2db WNM: Use country code, if available, to help in channel mapping
The country code from the current AP needs to be used in
ieee80211_chan_to_freq() to support cases where non-global operating
class table is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-24 10:57:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5d017065a0 GAS: Clean up Query Response length validation
Previous version was correct, but apparently too complex for some static
analyzers. (CID 68119)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
355e17eb1b HS 2.0: Clarify OSU Server URI length validation
The previous version was valid, but apparently too complex for some
static analyzers. Use a local variable for uri_len and explicitly
compare it against the remaining buffer length. (CID 68121)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5c58c0ce86 HS 2.0: More explicit hs20_osu_icon_fetch() length validation
The previous version was fine, but too much for some static analyzers to
understand as proper bounds checking. (CID 68122)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fecc09edc3 WNM: Use a clearer validation step for key_len_total
The previous one based on pointer arithmetic was apparently too much for
some static analyzers (CID 68130).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 18:04:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
43aee94899 Interworking: Clearer ANQP element length validation
The upper bound for the element length was already verified, but that
was not apparently noticed by a static analyzer (CID 68128).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 17:41:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f5f3728a81 WNM: Print debug message if Action frame sending fails
This makes wpa_drv_send_action() return value checking more consistent
(CID 75390).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 16:13:50 +02:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
70d1e72849 wpa_supplicant: Handle link measurement requests
Send link measurement response when a request is received. Advertise
only RCPI, computing it from the RSSI of the request. The TX power field
is left to be filled by the driver. All other fields are not published.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:45:07 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
66d2143435 wpa_cli: Add optional ssid to neighbor report request
Add optional 'ssid' parameter to command "neighbor_rep_request".

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:37:49 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
4c4b230527 wpa_supplicant: Add an option to specify SSID in neighbor report requests
Allow supplying an SSID for the SSID IE. If not supplied, no SSID IE is
sent, and the request implies the current SSID.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:36:42 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
fad14af93a wpa_cli: Add neighbor_rep_request command
Add neighbor_rep_request command to send a Neighbor Report Request
to the associated AP.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:29:41 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
f4b8bfae15 wpa_supplicant: Add NEIGHBOR_REP_REQUEST command to the control interface
Add NEIGHBOR_REP_REQUEST command to the wpa_supplicant ctrl_iface.
This command triggers the sending of a Neighbor Report Request to the
associated AP.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:28:52 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
d89c0701db wpa_supplicant: Add support for Neighbor Report
Add the ability to send a Neighbor Report Request (part of
RRM). Requester is then notified once the report arrives.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:23:14 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
b361d580ec SME: Add RRM support to association request
In case the AP we are associating with advertises support for RRM,
advertise our own RRM support in the (Re)Association Request frame. This
is done by adding an RRM Capabilities IE. The underlying driver is
expected to further add a Power Capabilities IE to the request, and set
the Radio Measurement flag in the Capability Info field. At this point
the RRM Capabilities IE advertises no measurement support.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:13:45 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
f936b73c4f wpa_supplicant: Store driver's RRM capabilities
Store the RRM capability flags reported by the underlying driver.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:07:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
75d65857d5 WNM: Use recent scan results on BSS transition request
If the last scans are recent (for now, less than ten seconds old), use
them instead of triggering a new scan when a BSS Transition Management
Request frame is received. As a fallback, allow a new scan to be
triggered if no matches were found.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 20:17:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e1117c1c01 WNM: Optimize BSS transition management scans
When the list of preferred transition candidates is received, use the
identified channels to optimize the following scan so that no time is
wasted on other channels.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 20:17:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d0b9ab69f6 WNM: Move transition candidate list processing to normal scan
This makes it easier to optimize transition request processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:40:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
279b5486a6 WNM: Fix TM candidate freeing if multiple requests are processed
The previously cached candidate list needs to be free properly through a
call to wnm_deallocate_memory() to ensure all subelements gets freed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:40:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
027454d2e9 WNM: Allow BSS transition request in same ESS even if RSSI is worse
This allows an AP to steer us to another BSS within the ESS even if that
results in reduced signal strength as long as the signal strength with
the target BSS is expected to provide some connectivity.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:06:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6900b6d96f WNM: Mark wnm_scan_response() static
This function is not used outside wnm_sta.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:06:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff2c5758bb WNM: Order BSS transmission candidate entries based on preference
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:06:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
093226783d WNM: Simplify how candidate subelements are stored
There is no need to use a separately allocated data structures for this.
A bitfield indicating which information is present and variables within
struct neighbor_report are simpler to use and more efficient.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:06:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8c9af762f3 WNM: Calculate valid-until time for transition candidate list
This is of more use than the raw validity interval (number of beacon
intervals) that was recorded previously.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 18:06:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4c381f0d1c WNM: Convert BSSID Info into a u32
This is more convenient to use than u8 array.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 17:03:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8040dc53c2 WNM: Debug print WNM BSS Transition Candidate List
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 16:34:34 +02:00
Thomas Pedersen
9e5e03d77e Add examples of new mesh options into wpa_supplicant.conf
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>
2014-11-20 16:31:09 +02:00
Johannes Berg
83b9d426e0 WMM AC: Notify driver before sending DelTS
Switch the stop and sending DelTS to avoid sending data packets
for the session after the DelTS, which is otherwise possible.

This also helps the mac80211 implementation as it requires stopping the
traffic flow before sending the DelTS as it may modify the AC parameters
for the affected queue, and that may in turn affect management frames.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-16 21:40:57 +02:00
Moshe Benji
8506ea6f17 WMM AC: Add wmm_ac_status control interface command
This wmm_ac_status command will show the current status for WMM AC.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:40:51 +02:00
Moshe Benji
df9d340c80 wpa_cli: WMM_AC_ADDTS and WMM_AC_DELTS commands
wmm_ac_addts command will add (or update) a traffic stream and
wmm_ac_delts command will delete an existing traffic stream.

Each of the above commands will call its corresponding
ctrl_iface command.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:16:03 +02:00
Moshe Benji
eb2f2088aa ctrl_iface: Add wmm_ac_addts and wmm_ac_delts commands
wmm_ac_addts command will add (or update) a traffic stream and
wmm_ac_delts command will delete an existing traffic stream.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:13:42 +02:00
Moshe Benji
d1f880013a WMM AC: Handle TSPEC action frames
Add the TSPEC to the driver on successful TSPEC ADDTS response. Delete
the TSPEC when receiving DELTS action.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:07:08 +02:00
Eliad Peller
674f6c073f WMM AC: Add basic ADDTS/DELTS sending functions
Add basic implementation for ADDTS and DELTS sending
functions.

wpas_wmm_ac_addts() will send ADDTS request public action,
containing TSPEC (traffic stream specification) with
the given params.

wpas_wmm_ac_delts() will look for the saved tspec with
the given tid, and send DELTS public action for it.

(Handling of ADDTS response and actually configuring the admission
control params will be added in following patches.)

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:03:56 +02:00